lyx_mirror/lib/doc/Customization.lyx

22289 lines
333 KiB
Plaintext
Raw Normal View History

#LyX 2.1 created this file. For more info see http://www.lyx.org/
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\lyxformat 446
\begin_document
\begin_header
\textclass scrbook
\begin_preamble
% DO NOT ALTER THIS PREAMBLE!!!
%
% This preamble is designed to ensure that this document prints
% out as advertised. If you mess with this preamble,
% parts of this document may not print out as expected. If you
% have problems LaTeXing this file, please contact
% the documentation team
% email: lyx-docs@lists.lyx.org
\usepackage{ifpdf} % part of the hyperref bundle
\ifpdf % if pdflatex is used
% set fonts for nicer pdf view
\IfFileExists{lmodern.sty}
{\usepackage{lmodern}}{}
\fi % end if pdflatex is used
% the pages of the TOC is numbered roman
% and a pdf-bookmark for the TOC is added
\let\myTOC\tableofcontents
\renewcommand\tableofcontents{%
\frontmatter
\pdfbookmark[1]{\contentsname}{}
\myTOC
\mainmatter }
\end_preamble
\options fleqn,bibliography=totoc,index=totoc,BCOR7.5mm,titlepage,captions=tableheading
\use_default_options false
\begin_modules
This commit changes the way individual LyXModule's are represented, both internally and in the .lyx files. The earlier version represented them by their `descriptive name', e.g., "Endnote" or "Theorems (AMS)", these being the same names used in the UI. This was a mistake, as becomes readily apparent when one starts to think about translating these strings. The modules ought to be represented by their filename, without the extension, just as TextClass's are. The changes that accomplish this part are in ModuleList.{h,cpp}, configure.py, and the *.module files themselves. This is a format change, and the lyx2lyx is in those files. By itself, that change would not be major, except for the fact that we do not want the module to be represented in the UI by its filename---e.g., theorems-std---but rather by a descriptive name, such as "Theorems". But that change turns out to be wholly non-trivial. The mechanism for choosing modules was the same as---indeed, was borrowed from---that in GuiCitation: You get a list of modules, and choosing them involves moving strings from one QListView to another. The models underlying these views are just QStringListModels, which means that, when you want to know what modules have been selected, you see what strings are in the "selected" QListView. But these are just the descriptive names, and we can't look up a module by its descriptive name if it's been translated. That, indeed, was the whole point of the change to the new representation. So, we need a more complicated model underlying the QListView, one that will pair an identifying string---the filename minus the extension, in this case---with each item. This turns out not to be terribly difficult, though it took rather a while for me to understand why it's not difficult. There are two parts: (i) GuiSelectionManger gets re-written to use any QAbstractListModel, not just a QStringListModel. This actually seems to improve the code, independently. (ii) We then subclass QAbstractListModel to get the associated ID string, using the Qt::UserRole slot associated with each item to store its ID. This would be almost completely trivial if QAbstractListItem::itemData() included the QVariant associated with this role, but it doesn't, so there are some additional hoops through which to jump. The new model, a GuiIdListModel, is defined in the files by that name. The changes in GuiSelectionManger.{h,cpp} make it more abstract; the changes in GuiDocument.{h,cpp} adapt it to the new framework. I've also updated the module documenation to accord with this change. git-svn-id: svn://svn.lyx.org/lyx/lyx-devel/trunk@22501 a592a061-630c-0410-9148-cb99ea01b6c8
2008-01-12 04:28:12 +00:00
logicalmkup
\end_modules
\maintain_unincluded_children false
\begin_local_layout
Format 35
InsetLayout Flex:MenuItem
LyxType charstyle
LabelString menu
LatexType command
LatexName menuitem
Font
Family Sans
EndFont
Preamble
\newcommand*{\menuitem}[1]{{\sffamily #1}}
EndPreamble
End
# In case we need to do with sans...
#InsetLayout CharStyle:Code
#Font
#Family Sans
#EndFont
#Preamble
#\renewcommand{\code}[1]{{\sffamily #1}}
#EndPreamble
#End
\end_local_layout
\language english
\language_package default
\inputencoding auto
\fontencoding global
\font_roman default
\font_sans default
\font_typewriter default
\font_math auto
\font_default_family default
\use_non_tex_fonts false
\font_sc false
\font_osf false
\font_sf_scale 100
\font_tt_scale 100
\graphics default
\default_output_format default
\output_sync 0
\bibtex_command default
\index_command default
\paperfontsize 12
\spacing single
\use_hyperref true
\pdf_title "LyX Configuration Manual"
\pdf_author "LyX Team"
\pdf_subject "LyX-documentation Customization"
\pdf_keywords "LyX, documentation, customization"
\pdf_bookmarks true
\pdf_bookmarksnumbered true
\pdf_bookmarksopen true
\pdf_bookmarksopenlevel 1
\pdf_breaklinks false
\pdf_pdfborder false
\pdf_colorlinks true
\pdf_backref false
\pdf_pdfusetitle false
\pdf_quoted_options "linkcolor=black, citecolor=black, urlcolor=blue, filecolor=blue,pdfpagelayout=OneColumn, pdfnewwindow=true, pdfstartview=XYZ, plainpages=false"
\papersize default
\use_geometry false
\use_package amsmath 0
\use_package amssymb 0
\use_package esint 0
\use_package mathdots 1
\use_package mathtools 0
\use_package mhchem 0
\use_package undertilde 0
\cite_engine basic
\cite_engine_type numerical
\biblio_style plain
\use_bibtopic false
\use_indices false
\paperorientation portrait
\suppress_date false
\justification true
\use_refstyle 0
\branch OutDated
\selected 0
\filename_suffix 0
\color #f5fae7
\end_branch
\index Index
\shortcut idx
\color #008000
\end_index
\secnumdepth 3
\tocdepth 3
\paragraph_separation indent
\paragraph_indentation default
\quotes_language english
\papercolumns 1
\papersides 2
\paperpagestyle headings
\tracking_changes true
\output_changes false
\html_math_output 0
\html_css_as_file 0
\html_be_strict true
2012-10-09 07:29:02 +00:00
\author -712698321 "Jürgen Spitzmüller"
\author -195340706 "Georg Baum"
\author 5863208 "ab"
\author 1082167584 "Kayvan Sylvan" kayvan@sylvan.com
\author 1414654397 "Richard Heck"
2012-11-24 16:14:06 +00:00
\author 2090807402 "usti"
\end_header
\begin_body
\begin_layout Title
Customizing LyX: Features for the Advanced User
\end_layout
\begin_layout Author
by the LyX Team
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\noindent
If you have comments or error corrections, please send them to the LyX Documenta
tion mailing list,
\begin_inset CommandInset href
LatexCommand href
target "lyx-docs@lists.lyx.org"
type "mailto:"
\end_inset
.
Include
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
[Customization]
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
in the subject header, and please cc the current maintainer of this file,
Richard Heck <rgheck@comcast.net>.
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
Version 2.0.x
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
\begin_inset CommandInset toc
LatexCommand tableofcontents
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
\begin_inset Note Note
status open
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Please use change tracking when modifying this document.
This makes it easier for our translators to recognize things that have
been changed, and it helps the maintainer keep up-to-date with what's been
done.
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Chapter
Introduction
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
This manual covers the customization features present in LyX.
In it, we discuss issues like keyboard shortcuts, screen previewing options,
printer options, sending commands to LyX via the LyX Server, internationalizati
on, installing new LaTeX classes and LyX layouts, etc.
We can't possibly hope to touch on everything you can change—our developers
add new features faster than we can document them—but we will explain the
most common customizations and hopefully point you in the right direction
for some of the more obscure ones.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
\begin_inset Branch OutDated
status collapsed
\begin_layout Standard
Information from previous versions of this document that now seems to be
outdated is contained in the OutDated branch of this document.
By default, this information will not appear in the LaTeX output.
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Chapter
LyX configuration files
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
This chapter aims to help you to find your way through the LyX configuration
files.
Before continuing to read this chapter, you should find out where your
LyX library and user directories are by using
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Help\SpecialChar \menuseparator
About
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
LyX
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
The library directory is the place where LyX places its system-wide configurati
on files; the user directory is where you can place your modified versions.
We will call the former
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LyXDir
\end_layout
\end_inset
and the latter
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UserDir
\end_layout
\end_inset
in the remainder of this document.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Section
What's in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LyXDir
\end_layout
\end_inset
?
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LyXDir
\end_layout
\end_inset
and its sub-directories contain a number of files and that can be used
to customize LyX's behavior.
You can change many of these files from within LyX itself through the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Tools\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Preferences
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog.
Most customization that you will want to do in LyX is possible through
this dialog.
However, many other inner aspects of LyX can be customized by modifying
the files in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LyXDir
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
These files fall in different categories, described in the following subsection
s.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Automatically generated files
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The files, which are to be found in
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UserDir
\end_layout
\end_inset
, are generated when you configure LyX.
They contain various default values that are guessed by inspection.
In general, it is not a good idea to modify them, since they might be overwritt
en at any time.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
lyxrc.defaults
\end_layout
\end_inset
contains defaults for various commands.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
packages.lst
\end_layout
\end_inset
contains the list of packages that have been recognized by LyX.
It is currently unused by the LyX program itself, but the information extracted
, and more, is made available with
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Help\SpecialChar \menuseparator
LaTeX
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
Configuration
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
textclass.lst
\end_layout
\end_inset
the list of text classes that have been found in your
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
layout/
\end_layout
\end_inset
directories, along with the associated LaTeX document class and their descripti
on.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
lyxmodules.lst
\end_layout
\end_inset
the list of layout modules found in your
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
layout/
\end_layout
\end_inset
directories
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
*files.lst
\end_layout
\end_inset
lists of various sorts of LaTeX-related files found on your system
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
doc/LaTeXConfig.lyx
\end_layout
\end_inset
is automatically generated during configuration from the file
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LaTeXConfig.lyx.in
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
It contains information on your LaTeX configuration.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Directories
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
These directories are duplicated between
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LyXDir
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UserDir
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
If a particular files exists in both places, the one in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UserDir
\end_layout
\end_inset
will be used.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
bind/
\end_layout
\end_inset
this directory contains files with the extension
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.bind
\end_layout
\end_inset
that define the keybindings used in LyX.
If there exists an internationalized version of the bind file named
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$LANG_xxx.bind
\end_layout
\end_inset
, that will be used first.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
clipart/
\end_layout
\end_inset
contains graphics files that can be included in documents.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
doc/
\end_layout
\end_inset
contains LyX documentation files (including the one you are currently reading).
The file
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LaTeXConfig.lyx
\end_layout
\end_inset
deserves special attention, as noted above.
The internationalized help docs are in subdirectories
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
doc/xx
\end_layout
\end_inset
where
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
xx
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
is the ISO language code.
See chapter
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "cha:Internationalizing-LyX"
\end_inset
for details.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
examples/
\end_layout
\end_inset
contains example files that explain how to use some features.
In the file browser, press the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Examples
\end_layout
\end_inset
button to get there.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
images/
\end_layout
\end_inset
contains image files that are used by the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Document
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog.
In addition, it also contains the individual icons used in the toolbar
and the banners that can be shown when LyX is launched.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
kbd/
\end_layout
\end_inset
contains keyboard keymapping files.
See Chapter
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sec:International-Keymap-Stuff"
\end_inset
for details.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
layouts/
\end_layout
\end_inset
contains the text class and module files described in Chapter
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "cha:Installing-New-Document"
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
lyx2lyx
\end_layout
\end_inset
contains the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
lyx2lyx
\end_layout
\end_inset
Python scripts used to convert between LyX versions.
These can be run from the command line if, say, you want to batch-convert
files.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
scripts/
\end_layout
\end_inset
contains some files that demonstrate the capabilities of the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
External
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
Template
\end_layout
\end_inset
feature.
Also contains some scripts used by LyX itself.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
templates/
\end_layout
\end_inset
contains the standard LyX template files described in Chapter
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Creating-Templates"
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ui/
\end_layout
\end_inset
contains files with the extension
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.ui
\end_layout
\end_inset
that define the user interface to LyX.
That is, the files define which items appear in which menus and the items
appearing on the toolbar.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Files you don't want to modify
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
These files are used internally by LyX and you generally do not need to
modify them unless you are a developer.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
CREDITS
\end_layout
\end_inset
this file contains the list of LyX developers.
The contents are displayed with the menu entry
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Help\SpecialChar \menuseparator
About
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
LyX
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
chkconfig.ltx
\end_layout
\end_inset
this is a LaTeX script used during the configuration process.
Do not run directly.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
configure.py
\end_layout
\end_inset
this is the script that is used to re-configure LyX.
It creates configuration files in the directory it was run from.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Other files needing a line or two...
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
encodings
\end_layout
\end_inset
this contains tables describing how different character encodings can be
mapped to Unicode
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
external_templates
\end_layout
\end_inset
this file contains the templates available to the new
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
External
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
Template
\end_layout
\end_inset
feature.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
languages
\end_layout
\end_inset
this file contains a list of all the languages currently supported by LyX.
\change_inserted -195340706 1334775793
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\change_inserted -195340706 1334775793
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -195340706 1334775793
layouttranslations
\end_layout
\end_inset
this file contains translations for internationalized paragraph styles
(see sec.
\begin_inset space \thinspace{}
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:I18n"
\end_inset
).
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\begin_layout Section
Your local configuration directory
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Even if you are using LyX as an unprivileged user, you might want to change
LyX configuration for your own use.
The
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UserDir
\end_layout
\end_inset
directory contains all your personal configuration files.
This is the directory described as
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
user directory
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
in
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Help\SpecialChar \menuseparator
About
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
LyX
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
This directory is used as a mirror of
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LyXDir
\end_layout
\end_inset
, which means that every file in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UserDir
\end_layout
\end_inset
is a replacement for the corresponding file in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LyXDir
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Any configuration file described in the above sections can be placed either
in the system-wide directory, in which case it will affect all users, or
in your local directory for your own use.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
To make things clearer, let's provide a few examples:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
The preferences set in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Tools\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Preferences
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog are saved to a file
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
preferences
\end_layout
\end_inset
in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UserDir
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
When you reconfigure using
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Tools\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Reconfigure
\end_layout
\end_inset
, LyX runs the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
configure.py
\end_layout
\end_inset
script, and the resulting files are written in your local configuration
directory.
This means that any additional text class file that you might have added
in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UserDir/layouts
\end_layout
\end_inset
will be added to the list of classes in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Document\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Settings
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
If you get some updated documentation from LyX ftp site and cannot install
it because you do not have sysadmin rights on your system, you can just
copy the files in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UserDir/doc/
\end_layout
\end_inset
and the items in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Help
\end_layout
\end_inset
menu will open them!
\end_layout
\begin_layout Section
Running LyX with multiple configurations
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The configuration freedom of the local configuration directory may not suffice
if you want to have more than one configuration at your disposal.
For example, you may want to be use different key bindings or printer settings
at different times.
You can achieve this by having several such directories.
You then specify which directory to use at run-time.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Invoking LyX with the command line switch
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
-userdir
\end_layout
\end_inset
\emph on
<some directory>
\emph default
instructs the program to read the configuration from that directory, and
not from the default directory.
(You can determine the default directory by running LyX without the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
-userdir
\end_layout
\end_inset
switch.) If the specified directory does not exist, LyX offers to create
it for you, just like it does for the default directory on the first time
you run the program.
You can modify the configuration options in this additional user directory
exactly as you would for the default directory.
These directories are completely independent (but read on).
Note that setting the environment variable
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LYX_USERDIR_VER
\end_layout
\end_inset
to some value has exactly the same effect.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Having several configurations also requires more maintenance: if you want
to add a new layout to
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
NewUserDir/layouts
\end_layout
\end_inset
which you want available from all your configurations, you must add it
to each directory separately.
You can avoid this with the following trick: after LyX creates the additional
directory, most of the subdirectories (see above) are empty.
If you want the new configuration to mirror an existing one, replace the
empty subdirectory with a symbolic link to the matching subdirectory in
the existing configuration.
Take care with the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
doc/
\end_layout
\end_inset
subdirectory, however, since it contains a file written by the configuration
script (also accessible through
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Tools\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Reconfigure
\end_layout
\end_inset
) which is configuration-specific.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Chapter
The Preferences dialog
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
All options of the preferences dialog are described in the Appendix
\emph on
The Preferences Dialog
\emph default
in the
\emph on
User's Guide
\emph default
.
For some options you might find here more details.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Section
Formats
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sec:Formats"
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The first step is to define your file formats if they are not already defined.
To do so, open the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Tools\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Preferences
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog.
Under
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
File Handling\SpecialChar \menuseparator
File formats
\end_layout
\end_inset
press the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
New\SpecialChar \ldots{}
\end_layout
\end_inset
button to define your new format.
The
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Format
\end_layout
\end_inset
field contains the name used to identify the format in the GUI.
The
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Short Name
\end_layout
\end_inset
is used to identify the format internally.
You will also need to enter a file extension.
These are all required.
The optional
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Shortcut
\end_layout
\end_inset
field is used to provide a keyboard shortcut on the menus.
(For example, pressing
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Alt-V F D
\end_layout
\end_inset
will
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
View\SpecialChar \menuseparator
View (Other Formats)\SpecialChar \menuseparator
DVI
\end_layout
\end_inset
.)
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
A Format can have a
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Viewer
\end_layout
\end_inset
and an
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Editor
\end_layout
\end_inset
associated with it.
For example, you might want to use
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Ghostview
\end_layout
\end_inset
to view PostScript files.
You can enter the command needed to start the program in the corresponding
fields.
In defining this command, you can use the four variables listed in the
next section.
The viewer is launched when you view an image in LyX or use the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
View
\end_layout
\end_inset
menu.
The editor is for example launched when you right-click on an image and
choose
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Edit externally
\end_layout
\end_inset
in the appearing context menu.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
\change_inserted -195340706 1329851811
The
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
MIME
\end_layout
\end_inset
type of a format is optional, but if it is specified, it must be unique
across all formats.
It is used to detect files of this format from the file contents.
For some important file formats there is no MIME type officially registered
with the
\begin_inset CommandInset href
LatexCommand href
name "IANA"
target "http://www.iana.org/assignments/media-types/"
\end_inset
.
Therefore LyX uses the extended list of MIME types as specified by
\begin_inset CommandInset href
LatexCommand href
name "freedesktop.org"
target "http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/shared-mime-info-spec"
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Document format
\end_layout
\end_inset
option tells LyX that a format is suitable for document export.
If this is set and if a suitable conversion route exists (see sec.
\begin_inset space \thinspace{}
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sec:Converters"
\end_inset
), the format will appear in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
File\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Export
\end_layout
\end_inset
menu.
The format will also appear in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
View
\end_layout
\end_inset
menu if a viewer is specified for the format.
Pure image formats, such as
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
png
\end_layout
\end_inset
, should not use this option.
Formats that can both represent vector graphics and documents like
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
pdf
\end_layout
\end_inset
should use it.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The option
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Vector graphics format
\end_layout
\end_inset
tells LyX that a format can contain vector graphics.
This information is used to determine the target format of included graphics
for
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
pdflatex
\end_layout
\end_inset
export.
Included graphics may need to be converted to either
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
pdf
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
png
\end_layout
\end_inset
, or
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
jpg
\end_layout
\end_inset
, since
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
pdflatex
\end_layout
\end_inset
cannot handle other image formats.
If an included graphic is not already in
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
pdf
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
png
\end_layout
\end_inset
, or
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
jpg
\end_layout
\end_inset
format, it is converted to
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
pdf
\end_layout
\end_inset
if the vector format option is set, and otherwise to
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
png
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Section
Copiers
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Since all conversions from one format to another take place in LyX's temporary
directory, it is sometimes necessary to modify a file before copying it
to the temporary directory in order that the conversion may be performed.
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
For example, the file may refer to other files—images, for example—using
relative file names, and these may become invalid when the file is copied
to the temporary directory.
\end_layout
\end_inset
This is done by a Copier: It copies a file to (or from) the temporary directory
and may modify it in the process.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The definitions of the copiers may use four variables:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$s
\end_layout
\end_inset
The LyX system directory (e.
\begin_inset space \thinspace{}
\end_inset
g.
\begin_inset space \space{}
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
/usr/share/lyx
\end_layout
\end_inset
).
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$i
\end_layout
\end_inset
The input file
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$o
\end_layout
\end_inset
The output file
\change_inserted 1082167584 1348453985
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\change_inserted 1082167584 1348453986
$$b The base name (without filename extension) in the LyX temporary directory
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\change_inserted 1082167584 1348453986
$$p The full directory path of the LyX temporary directory
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\change_inserted 1082167584 1348453986
$$r The full pathname to the original LyX file being processed
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\change_inserted 1082167584 1348453986
$$f The filename (without any directory path) of the LyX file.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$l
\end_layout
\end_inset
The `LaTeX name'
\change_inserted 1082167584 1348453720
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The latter should be the filename as it would be used in a LaTeX's
\series bold
\backslash
include
\series default
command.
It is relevant only when exporting files suitable for such inclusion.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Copiers can be used to do almost anything with output files.
For example, suppose you want generated pdf files to be copied to a special
directory,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
/home/you/pdf/
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Then you could write a shell script such as this one:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
\begin_inset listings
inline false
status open
\begin_layout Plain Layout
#!/bin/bash
\end_layout
\begin_layout Plain Layout
FROMFILE=$1
\end_layout
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TOFILE=`basename $2`
\end_layout
\begin_layout Plain Layout
cp $FROMFILE /home/you/pdf/$TOFILE
\end_layout
\end_inset
Save it in your local LyX directory—say,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
/home/you/.lyx/scripts/pdfcopier.sh
\end_layout
\end_inset
—and make it executable, if you need to do so on your platform.
Then, in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Tools\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Preferences
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog, select under
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
File Handling\SpecialChar \menuseparator
File formats
\end_layout
\end_inset
the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
PDF(pdflatex)
\end_layout
\end_inset
format—or one of the other pdf formats—and enter
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
pdfcopier.sh $$i $$o
\end_layout
\end_inset
into the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Copier
\end_layout
\end_inset
field.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Copiers are used by LyX in various of its own conversions.
For example, if appropriate programs are found, LyX will automatically
install copiers for the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTML
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTML
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
(MS Word)
\end_layout
\end_inset
formats.
When these formats are exported, the copier sees that not just the main
HTML file but various associated files (style files, images, etc.) are also
copied.
All these files are written to a subdirectory of the directory in which
the original LyX file was found.
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
This copier can be customized.
The optional
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
-e
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
argument takes a comma-separated list of extensions to be copied; if it
is omitted, all files will be copied.
The
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
-t
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
argument determines the extension added to the generated directory.
By default, it is
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LyXconv
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
, so HTML generated from
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
/path/to/filename.lyx
\end_layout
\end_inset
will end up in
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
/path/to/filename.html.LyXconv
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Section
Converters
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sec:Converters"
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
You can define your own Converters to convert files between different formats.
This is done in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Tools\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Preferences\SpecialChar \menuseparator
File Handling\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Converters
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
To define a new converter, select the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
From
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
format
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
To
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
format
\end_layout
\end_inset
from the drop-down lists, enter the command needed for the conversion,
and then press the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Add
\end_layout
\end_inset
button.
Several variables can be used in the definition of converters:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$s
\end_layout
\end_inset
The LyX system directory
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$i
\end_layout
\end_inset
The input file
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$o
\end_layout
\end_inset
The output file
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$b
\end_layout
\end_inset
The base filename of the input file (i.
\begin_inset space \thinspace{}
\end_inset
g., without the extension)
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$p
\end_layout
\end_inset
The path to the input file
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$r
\end_layout
\end_inset
The path to the original input file (this is different from $$p when a
chain of converters is called)
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$e
\end_layout
\end_inset
The iconv name for the encoding of the document.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
In the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Extra
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
Flag
\end_layout
\end_inset
field you can enter the following flags, separated by commas:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
latex
\end_layout
\end_inset
This converter runs some form of LaTeX.
This will make LyX's LaTeX error logs available.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
needaux
\end_layout
\end_inset
Needs the LaTeX
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.aux
\end_layout
\end_inset
file for the conversion.
\change_inserted 1414654397 1337693117
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\change_inserted 1414654397 1337693188
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted 1414654397 1337693129
nice
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
Needs a
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
nice
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
file from the backend, which in practice means a LaTeX file like the one
we would export, without
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted 1414654397 1337693184
input@path
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
xml
\end_layout
\end_inset
Output is XML.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The following three flags are not really flags at all because they take
an argument in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
key
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
=
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
value
\end_layout
\end_inset
format:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
parselog
\end_layout
\end_inset
If set, the converter's standard error will be redirected to a file
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
infile.out
\end_layout
\end_inset
, and the script given as argument will be run as:
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
script < infile.out > infile.log
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
The argument may contain
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$s
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
resultdir
\end_layout
\end_inset
The name of the directory in which the converter will dump the generated
files.
LyX will not create this directory, and it does not copy anything into
it, though it will copy this directory to the destination.
The argument may contain
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$b
\end_layout
\end_inset
, which will be replaced by the base name of the input and output files,
respectively, when the directory is copied.
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
Note that resultdir and usetempdir make no sense together.
The latter will be ignored if the former is given.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
resultfile
\end_layout
\end_inset
Determines the output file name and may, contain
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$b
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Sensible only with resultdir and optional even then; if not given, it defaults
to `index'.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
None of these last three are presently used in any of the converters that
are installed with LyX.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
You do not have to define converters for all formats between which you want
to convert.
For example, you will note that there is no `LyX to PostScript' converter,
but LyX will export PostScript.
It does so by first creating a LaTeX file (no converter needs to be defined
for this) which is then converted to DVI using the `LaTeX to DVI' converter,
and finally converting the resulting DVI file to PostScript.
LyX finds such `chains' of converters automatically, and it will always
choose the shortest possible chain.
You can, though, still define multiple conversion methods between file
formats.
For example, the standard LyX configuration provides three ways to convert
LaTeX to PDF: Directly, using
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
pdflatex
\end_layout
\end_inset
; via (DVI and) PostScript, using
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ps2pdf
\end_layout
\end_inset
; or via DVI, using
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
dvipdfm
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
To define such alternate chains, you must define multiple target `file
formats', as described in section
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sec:Formats"
\end_inset
.
For example, in the standard configuration, the formats named
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
pdf
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
pdf2
\end_layout
\end_inset
, and
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
pdf3
\end_layout
\end_inset
are defined, all of which share the extension
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.pdf
\end_layout
\end_inset
, and which correspond to the conversion methods just mentioned.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Chapter
Internationalizing LyX
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "cha:Internationalizing-LyX"
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
LyX supports using a translated interface.
Last time we checked, LyX provided text in thirty languages.
The language of choice is called your
\emph on
locale
\emph default
.
(For further reading on locale settings, see also the documentation for
locale that comes with your operating system.
For Linux, the manual page for
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
locale(5)
\end_layout
\end_inset
could be a good place to start).
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Notice that these translations will work, but do contain a few flaws.
In particular, all dialogs have been designed with the English text in
mind, which means that some of the translated text will be too large to
fit within the space allocated.
This is only a display problem and will not cause any harm.
Also, you will find that some of the translations do not define shortcut
keys for everything.
Sometimes, there are simply not enough free letters to do it.
Other times, the translator just hasn't got around to doing it yet.
Our localization team, which you may wish to join,
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
If you are a fluent speaker of a language other than English, joining these
teams is a great way to give back to the LyX community!
\end_layout
\end_inset
will of course try to fix these shortcomings in future versions of LyX.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Section
Translating LyX
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Translating the graphical user interface (text messages).
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
LyX uses the GNU
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
gettext
\end_layout
\end_inset
library to handle the internationalization of the interface.
To have LyX speak your favorite language in all menus and dialogs, you
need a
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
po
\end_layout
\end_inset
-file for that language.
When this is available, you'll have to generate a
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
mo
\end_layout
\end_inset
-file from it and install the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
mo
\end_layout
\end_inset
-file.
The process of doing all of this is explained in the documentation for
GNU
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
gettext
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
It is possible to do this just for yourself, but if you're going to do
it, you might as well share the results of your labors with the rest of
the LyX community.
Send a message to the LyX developers' list for more information about how
to proceed.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
In short, this is what you should do (xx denotes the language code):
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
Check out the LyX source code.
(See the
\begin_inset CommandInset href
LatexCommand href
name "information on the web"
target "http://www.lyx.org/HowToUseSVN"
\end_inset
.)
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
Copy the file
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
lyx.pot
\end_layout
\end_inset
to the folder of the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
**.po
\end_layout
\end_inset
files.
Then rename it to
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
xx.po
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
(If
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
lyx.pot
\end_layout
\end_inset
doesn't exist anywhere, it can be remade with the console command
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
make lyx.pot
\end_layout
\end_inset
in that directory, or you can use an existing po-file for some other language
as a template).
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
Edit
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
xx.po
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
This is just a text file, so it can be edited in any text editor.
But there are also specialized programs that support such editing, such
as
\family typewriter
Poedit
\family default
(for all platforms) or
\family typewriter
KBabel
\family default
(for KDE).
\family typewriter
Emacs
\family default
contains a `mode' for editing
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
po
\end_layout
\end_inset
files, as well.
\end_layout
\end_inset
For some menu- and widget-labels, there are also shortcut keys that should
be translated.
Those keys are marked after a `|', and should be translated according to
the words and phrases of the language.
You should also fill also out the information at the beginning of the new
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
po
\end_layout
\end_inset
-file with your email-address, etc., so people know where to reach you with
suggestions and entertaining flames.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
If you are just doing this on your own, then:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
Generate
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
xx.mo
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
This can be done with
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
msgfmt -o xx.mo < xx.po
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
Copy the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
mo
\end_layout
\end_inset
-file to your locale-tree, at the correct directory for application messages
for the language
\series bold
\series default
xx, and under the name
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
lyx.mo
\end_layout
\end_inset
(e.
\begin_inset space \thinspace{}
\end_inset
g.
\begin_inset space \space{}
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
/usr/local/share/locale/xx/LC_MESSAGES/lyx.mo
\end_layout
\end_inset
\series bold
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
As said, however, it would be best if the new
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
po
\end_layout
\end_inset
-file could be added to the LyX distribution, so others can use it.
Adding it involves making additional changes to LyX.
So send an email to the developers' mailing list if you're interested in
doing that.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsubsection
Ambiguous messages
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Sometimes it turns out that one English message needs to be translated into
different messages in the target language.
One example is the message
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
To
\end_layout
\end_inset
which has the German translation
\lang german
Nach
\lang english
or
\lang german
Bis
\lang english
, depending upon exactly what the English
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
to
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
means.
GNU
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
gettext
\end_layout
\end_inset
does not handle such ambiguous translations.
Therefore you have to add some context information to the message: Instead
of
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
To
\end_layout
\end_inset
it becomes
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
To[[as in 'From format x to format y']]
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
To[[as in 'From page x to page y']].
\end_layout
\end_inset
Now the two occurrences of
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
To
\end_layout
\end_inset
are different for
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
gettext
\end_layout
\end_inset
and can be translated correctly to
\lang german
Nach
\lang english
and
\lang german
Bis
\lang english
, respectively.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Of course the context information needs to be stripped off the original
message when no translation is used.
Therefore you have to put it in double square brackets at the end of the
message (see the example above).
The translation mechanism of LyX ensures that everything in double square
brackets at the end of messages is removed before displaying the message.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Translating the documentation.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The online documentation (in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Help
\end_layout
\end_inset
-menu) can (and should!) be translated.
If there are translated versions of the documentation available
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
As of March 2008, at least some of the documents have been translated into
fourteen languages, with the Tutorial available in a few more.
\end_layout
\end_inset
and the locale is set accordingly, these will be used automagically by
LyX.
LyX looks for translated versions as
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LyXDir/doc/xx/DocName.lyx
\end_layout
\end_inset
, where
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
xx
\end_layout
\end_inset
is the code for the language currently in use.
If there are no translated documents, the default English versions will
be displayed.
Note that the translated versions must have the same filenames (
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
DocName
\end_layout
\end_inset
above) as the original.
If you feel up to translating the documentation (an excellent way to proof-read
the original documentation by the way!), there are a few things you should
do right away:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
Check out the documentation translation web page at
\begin_inset CommandInset href
LatexCommand href
name "http://www.lyx.org/Translation"
target "http://www.lyx.org/Translation"
\end_inset
.
That way, you can find out which (if any) documents have already been translate
d into your language.
You can also find out who (if anyone) is organizing the effort to translate
the documentation into your language.
If no one is organizing the effort, please let us know that you're interested.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Once you get to actually translating, here's a few hints for you that may
save you trouble:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
Join the documentation team! There is information on how to do that in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Intro.lyx
\end_layout
\end_inset
(
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Help\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Introduction
\end_layout
\end_inset
), which by the way is the first document you should translate.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
Learn the typographic conventions for the language you are translating to.
Typography is an ancient art and over the centuries, a great variety of
conventions have developed throughout different parts of the world.
Also study the professional terminology amongst typographers in your country.
Inventing your own terminology will only confuse the users.
\emph on
(Warning! Typography is addictive!)
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
Make a copy of the document.
This will be your working copy.
You can use this as your personal translated help-file by placing it in
your
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UserDir/doc/xx/
\end_layout
\end_inset
directory.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
Sometimes the original document (from the LyX-team) will be updated.
Use the source viewer at
\begin_inset CommandInset href
LatexCommand href
name "http://www.lyx.org/trac/timeline"
target "http://www.lyx.org/trac/timeline"
\end_inset
to see what has been changed.
That way you can easily see which parts of the translated document need
to be updated.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
If you ever find an error in the original document, fix it and notify the
rest of the documentation team of the changes! (You didn't forget to join
the documentation team, did you?)
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
\begin_inset Branch OutDated
status collapsed
\begin_layout Section
International Keyboard Support
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
\emph on
[Editor's Note: The following section is by
\emph default
\shape smallcaps
\emph on
Ivan Schreter
\shape default
.
It needs to be fixed to conform to the new Documentation Style sheet and
to make use of the new v1.0 features.
The whole thing also needs to be merged with the section following it.-jw
It may also be badly out of date.-rh (2008)]
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Defining Own Keymaps: Keymap File Format
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Let's look at a keyboard definition file a little closer.
It is a plain text file defining
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
key-to-key or key-to-string translations
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
dead keys
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
dead keys exceptions
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
To define key-to-key or key-to-string translation, use this command:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
kmap
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
key
\end_layout
\end_inset
outstring
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
where
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
key
\end_layout
\end_inset
is the key to be translated and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
outstring
\end_layout
\end_inset
is the string to be inserted into the document.
To define dead keys, use:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
kmod
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
key
\end_layout
\end_inset
deadkey
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
where
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
key
\end_layout
\end_inset
is a keyboard key and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
deadkey
\end_layout
\end_inset
is dead key name.
The following dead keys are supported (shortcut name is in parentheses):
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
\emph on
Name
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
Example
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
acute (acu)
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
áéíóú
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
grave (gra)
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
àèìòù
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
macron (mac)
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
ō
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
tilde (til)
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
ñÑ
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
underbar (underb)
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
\begin_inset ERT
status open
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
b o
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
cedilla (ced)
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
çÇ
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
underdot (underd)
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
\begin_inset ERT
status open
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
d o
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
circumflex (circu)
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
âêîôû
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
circle (circl)
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
ÅůŮ
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
tie (tie)
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
\begin_inset ERT
status open
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
t o
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
breve (bre)
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
ă
\begin_inset ERT
status open
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
u o
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
caron (car)
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
čšž
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
hungarian umlaut (hug)
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
őű
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
umlaut (uml)
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
äöü
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
dot (dot)
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
ż
\begin_inset ERT
status open
\begin_layout Plain Layout
* src/format.[Ch] (document_): new flag, telling whether this is a document format and we want to show this format in the export and view menus (documentFormat): accessor for document_ * src/format.h: Add some documentation * src/frontends/qt3/QPrefsDialog.C (QPrefsDialog::QPrefsDialog): handle new documentCB checkbox (QPrefsDialog::switch_format): ditto (QPrefsDialog::updateFormatsButtons): ditto (QPrefsDialog::new_format): ditto (QPrefsDialog::modify_format): ditto * src/frontends/qt3/ui/QPrefFileformatsModule.ui: Add documentCB checkbox * src/frontends/qt4/QPrefsDialog.C (QPrefsDialog::QPrefsDialog): handle new documentCB checkbox (QPrefsDialog::switch_format): ditto (QPrefsDialog::updateFormatsButtons): ditto (QPrefsDialog::new_format): ditto (QPrefsDialog::modify_format): ditto * src/frontends/qt4/ui/QPrefFileformatsUi.ui: Add documentCB checkbox * src/frontends/xforms/FormPreferences.C (FormPreferences::Formats::build): handle new check_document checkbox (FormPreferences::Formats::input): ditto (FormPreferences::Formats::Add): ditto (FormPreferences::Formats::Browser): ditto * src/frontends/xforms/forms/form_preferences.fd: Add check_document checkbox * src/lyxrc.C (LyXRC::read): Remove compatibility code for 1.3 \format entries. Read the new format flags (but don't require them for 1.4 compatibility) (LyXRC::write): Write the new format flags * src/MenuBackend.C (expandFormats): Remove the hardcoded exception for image formats and use Format::isDocument() instead * lib/doc/Customization.lyx: Document auto viever/editor and the "document format" flag git-svn-id: svn://svn.lyx.org/lyx/lyx-devel/trunk@13887 a592a061-630c-0410-9148-cb99ea01b6c8
2006-05-20 12:03:40 +00:00
\backslash
.s
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Since in many international keyboards there are exceptions to what some
dead keys should do, you can define them using
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
kxmod
\end_layout
\end_inset
deadkey key outstring
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
For example, on Slovak keyboard, if you enter caron-o, it generates circumflex-o
, so you put in
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quotation
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
kxmod
\end_layout
\end_inset
caron o "
\backslash
^o"
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
to make it work correctly.
Also, you have to define as exceptions dead keys over i and j, to remove
the dot from them before inserting an accent mark.
I will change this when the time comes, but so far I haven't had time.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Oh, and about characters: backslash is escaped, so to enter it, you'll need
double backslash.
Also, quotes and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
#
\end_layout
\end_inset
have different meaning.
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
#
\end_layout
\end_inset
marks comments, quotes start and end LaTeX-style commands.
To enter quote, you'll need to use
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
"
\end_layout
\end_inset
, to enter
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
#
\end_layout
\end_inset
, use
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
#
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
If you make a keyboard description file that works for your language, please
mail it to me, so I can include it in the next keymap distribution.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
More keywords will be supported in keymap configuration file in future,
like
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
kinclude filename
\end_layout
\end_inset
\emph on
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
include
\end_layout
\end_inset
another file
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
kprog program
\end_layout
\end_inset
\emph on
\begin_inset space \hfill{}
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
define
\end_layout
\end_inset
an external keymap translation program
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Also, it should look into
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
lyxrc
\end_layout
\end_inset
file for defaults, too (for example, a
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
kinclude
\end_layout
\end_inset
option to include default keyboard).
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Section
International Keymap Stuff
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sec:International-Keymap-Stuff"
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
\begin_inset Note Note
status open
\begin_layout Plain Layout
In doing the revisions on this document in March 2008, I did not look over
this stuff, as I do not understand it.
It would be good if someone else could do so.
(RH)
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The next two sections describe the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
.kmap
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
.cdef
\end_layout
\end_inset
file syntax in detail.
These sections should help you design your own key map if the ones provided
do not meet your needs.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
The .kmap File
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
A
\shape up
.
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
kmap
\end_layout
\end_inset
file maps keystrokes to characters or strings.
As the name suggests, it sets a keyboard mapping.
The
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.kmap
\end_layout
\end_inset
\shape default
file keywords
\shape up
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
kmap
\end_layout
\end_inset
\shape default
,
\shape up
\shape default
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
kmod
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\shape up
\shape default
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
kxmod
\end_layout
\end_inset
, and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
kcomb
\end_layout
\end_inset
are described in this section.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
kmap
\end_layout
\end_inset
Map a character to a string
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
kmap
\family roman
\emph on
char
\family default
\emph default
\family roman
\emph on
string
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
This will ma
\family roman
p
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
char
\family default
\emph default
\family roman
to
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
string
\emph default
.
Note that in
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
string
\emph default
,
\family default
\family roman
\shape up
the double-quote (")
\family default
\shape default
\family roman
and
\family default
\family roman
\shape up
the backslash (
\backslash
)
\family default
\shape default
\family roman
must be escaped with a preceding backslash (
\shape up
\backslash
\shape default
)
\family default
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
An example of a
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
kmap
\end_layout
\end_inset
statement to cause the symbol
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
/
\end_layout
\end_inset
to be output for the keystroke
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
&
\end_layout
\end_inset
is:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
kmap & /
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
kmod
\end_layout
\end_inset
Specify an accent character
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
kmod
\family roman
\emph on
char accent allowed
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
This will make the cha
\family roman
racter
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
char
\family default
\emph default
\family roman
\shape up
\emph on
be an accent
\family default
\shape default
\emph default
\family roman
\shape up
on the
\family default
\shape default
\family roman
\shape up
\emph on
allowed
\family default
\shape default
\emph default
\family roman
\shape up
cha
\family default
racter(s).
This is the dead key
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
The term
\family roman
\emph on
dead key
\family default
\emph default
refers to a key that does not produce a character by itself, but when followed
with another key, produces the desired accent character.
For example, a German characte
\family roman
r with an umlaut like
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
ä
\family default
\emph default
\family roman
can be produced in this manner.
\end_layout
\end_inset
mechanism.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
If you
\family roman
hit
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
char
\family default
\emph default
\family roman
and then another key not in
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
allowed
\emph default
, you will get a
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
char
\family default
\emph default
\family roman
followed by the other, not allowed key, as output.
\family default
Note that a
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
Backspace
\end_layout
\end_inset
cancels a dead key, so if
\family roman
you hit
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
char
\family default
\emph default
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
\emph on
Backspace
\end_layout
\end_inset
, the cursor will not go one position backwards but will instead cancel
the effect t
\family roman
hat
\family default
\family roman
\shape up
\emph on
char
\family default
\shape default
\emph default
\family roman
\shape up
might have had on the next keystroke.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The following example specifies that the character ' is to be an acute accent,
allowed on the characters a, e, i, o, u, A, E, I, O, and U:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
kmod ' acute aeiouAEIOU
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
kxmod
\end_layout
\end_inset
Specify an exception to the accent character
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
kxmod
\family roman
\emph on
accent char result
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
This defines an exce
\family roman
ption for
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
accent
\family default
\emph default
\family roman
on
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
char
\emph default
.
T
\shape up
he
\family default
\shape default
\family roman
\shape up
\emph on
accent
\family default
\shape default
\emph default
\family roman
\shape up
must
\family default
\shape default
\shape up
have been assigned a keystroke with a previous
\shape default
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
\backslash
kmo
\shape default
d
\end_layout
\end_inset
declar
\family roman
ation and
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
char
\family default
\emph default
\family roman
must not belong in the
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
allowed
\family default
\emph default
\family roman
set of
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
accent
\emph default
.
When
\family default
\family roman
\shape up
you enter the
\family default
\shape default
\family roman
\shape up
\emph on
accent char
\family default
\shape default
\emph default
\family roman
\shape up
sequence,
\family default
\shape default
\family roman
\shape up
\emph on
result
\emph default
is produced.
If such a declaration does not exist in
\family default
\shape default
\shape up
the
\shape default
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
.kmap
\end_layout
\end_inset
file and yo
\family roman
u enter
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
accent char
\emph default
, you get
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
accent_key char
\emph default
where
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
accent_key
\emph default
is the first arg
\family default
ument of the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
\backslash
kmod
\end_layout
\end_inset
declaration.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The following command produces causes äi to be produced when you enter acute-i
('i):
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
kxmod acute i "
\backslash
\backslash
'{
\backslash
\backslash
i}"
\end_layout
\begin_layout Labeling
\labelwidthstring 00.00.0000
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
kcomb
\end_layout
\end_inset
Combine two accent characters
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
kcomb
\family roman
\emph on
accent1 accent2 allowed
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
This one is getting pretty esoteric.
It allows you to combine the effect
\family roman
of
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
accent1
\family default
\emph default
\family roman
and
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
accent2
\family default
\emph default
\family roman
(in that order!) on
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
allowed
\family default
\emph default
\family roman
chars.
The keystrokes for
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
accent1
\family default
\emph default
\family roman
and
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
accent2
\family default
\emph default
\family roman
must have be
\family default
en set with a
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
\backslash
kmod
\end_layout
\end_inset
command at
\family roman
a
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
previous
\family default
\emph default
\family roman
point in the
\family default
file.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Consider this example from the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
greek.kmap
\end_layout
\end_inset
file:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
kmod ; acute aeioyvhAEIOYVH
\backslash
kmod : umlaut iyIY
\backslash
kcomb acute umlaut iyIY
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
This allows you to press
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
;:i
\end_layout
\end_inset
and get the effect of
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
\backslash
'{
\backslash
"{i}}
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\family roman
\shape up
A backspace
\family default
\shape default
in this case cancels the last dead key, so if you press
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
;: Backspace i
\end_layout
\end_inset
you get
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
\backslash
'{i}
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
The .cdef File
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
After the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
.kmap
\end_layout
\end_inset
mapping is performed, a
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
.cde
\shape default
f
\end_layout
\end_inset
file maps the strings that the symbols generate to characters in the current
font.
The LyX distribution currently includes at least the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
iso8859-1.cdef
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
iso8859-2.cdef
\end_layout
\end_inset
files.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
In general the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
.cdef
\end_layout
\end_inset
file is a sequence of declarations of the form
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\family roman
\emph on
char_index_in_set
\family default
\emph default
\family roman
\emph on
string
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
For example, in order to map
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\shape up
\backslash
'{e}
\end_layout
\end_inset
to the corresponding character in the iso-8859-1 set (233), the following
declaration is used
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
233 "
\backslash
\backslash
'{e}"
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
with
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
"
\end_layout
\end_inset
being escap
\family roman
ed in
\family default
\family roman
\emph on
string
\emph default
.
Note that
\family default
the same character can apply to more than one string.
In the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
i
\shape up
so-8859-7.cdef
\end_layout
\end_inset
file you have
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
192 "
\backslash
\backslash
'{
\backslash
\backslash
\backslash
"{i}}"
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
192 "
\backslash
\backslash
\backslash
"{
\backslash
\backslash
'{i}}"
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
If LyX cannot find a mapping for the string produced by the keystroke or
a deadkey sequence, it will check if it looks like an accented char and
try to draw an accent over the character on screen.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Dead Keys
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
There is a second way to add support for international characters through
so-called dead-keys.
A dead-key works in combination with a letter to produce an accented character.
Here, we'll explain how to create a really simple dead-key to illustrate
how they work.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Suppose you happen to need the circumflex character,
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
̂
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
You could bind the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
^
\end_layout
\end_inset
-key [a.k.a.
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Shift-6
\end_layout
\end_inset
] to the LyX command
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
accent-circumflex
\end_layout
\end_inset
in your
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
lyxrc
\end_layout
\end_inset
file.
Now, whenever you type the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
^
\end_layout
\end_inset
-key followed by a letter, that letter will have a circumflex accent on
it.
For example, the sequence
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
^e
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
produces the letter:
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
ê
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
If you tried to type
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
^t
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
, however, LyX will complain with a beep, since a
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
t
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
never takes a circumflex accent.
Hitting
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Space
\end_layout
\end_inset
after a dead-key produces the bare-accent.
Please note this last point! If you bind a key to a dead-key, you'll need
to rebind the character on that key to yet another key.
Binding the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
,-key
\end_layout
\end_inset
to a cedilla is a bad idea, since you'll only get cedillas instead of commas.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
One common way to bind dead-keys is to use
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Meta-
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Ctrl-
\end_layout
\end_inset
, and
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Shift-
\end_layout
\end_inset
in combination with an accent, like
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
~
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
or
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
,
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
or
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
^
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
Another way involves using
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
xmodmap
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
xkeycaps
\end_layout
\end_inset
to set up the special
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Mode_Switch
\end_layout
\end_inset
key.
The
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Mode_Switch
\end_layout
\end_inset
acts in some ways just like
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Shift
\end_layout
\end_inset
and permits you to bind keys to accented characters.
You can also turn keys into dead-keys by binding them to something like
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
usldead_cedilla
\end_layout
\end_inset
and then binding this symbolic key to the corresponding LyX command.
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Note from
\noun on
John Weiss
\noun default
: This is exactly what I do in my
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
~/.lyx/lyxrc
\end_layout
\end_inset
and my
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
~/.xmodmap
\end_layout
\end_inset
files.
I have my
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Scroll
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
Lock
\end_layout
\end_inset
key set up as
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Mode_Shift
\end_layout
\end_inset
and a bunch of these
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
usldead_*
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
symbolic keys bound such things as
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Scroll
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
Lock-^
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Scroll
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
Lock-~
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
This is how I produce my accented characters.
\end_layout
\end_inset
You can make just about anything into the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Mode_Switch
\end_layout
\end_inset
key: One of the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Ctrl-
\end_layout
\end_inset
keys, a spare function key, etc.
As for the LyX commands that produce accents, check the entry for
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
accent-acute
\end_layout
\end_inset
in the
\emph on
Reference Manual
\emph default
.
You'll find the complete list there.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Saving your Language Configuration
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
You can edit your preferences so that your desired language environment
is automatically configured when LyX starts up, via the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Edit\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Preferences
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Chapter
Installing New Document Classes, Layouts, and Templates
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "cha:Installing-New-Document"
\end_inset
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\begin_inset Argument 1
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Installing New Document Classes
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
In this chapter, we describe the procedures for creating and installing
new LyX layout and template files, as well as offer a refresher on correctly
installing new LaTeX document classes.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
First, let us a say a few words about how one ought to think about the relation
between LyX and LaTeX.
The thing to understand is that, in a certain sense, LyX doesn't know anything
about LaTeX.
Indeed, from LyX's point of view, LaTeX is just one of several
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
backend formats
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
in which it is capable of producing output.
Other such formats are DocBook, plaintext, and XHTML.
LaTeX is, of course, a particularly important format, but very little of
the information LyX has about LaTeX is actually contained in the program
itself.
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Some commands are sufficiently complex that they are
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
hardcoded
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
into LyX.
But the developers generally regard this as a Bad Thing.
\end_layout
\end_inset
Rather, that information, even for the standard classes like
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
article.cls
\end_layout
\end_inset
, is contained in `layout files'.
Similarly, LyX itself does not know much about DocBook or XHTML.
What it knows is contained in layout files.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
You can think of the layout file for a given document class as a translation
manual between LyX constructs---paragraphs with their corresponding styles,
certain sorts of insets, etc---and the corresponding LaTeX, DocBook, or
XHTML constructs.
Almost everything LyX knows about
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
article.cls
\end_layout
\end_inset
, for example, is contained in the file
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
article.layout
\end_layout
\end_inset
and in various other files it includes.
For this reason, anyone intending to write layout files should plan to
study the existing files.
A good place to start is with
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
stdsections.inc
\end_layout
\end_inset
, which is included in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
article.layout
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
book.layout
\end_layout
\end_inset
, and many of the other layout files for document classes.
This file is where sections and the like are defined:
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
stdsections.inc
\end_layout
\end_inset
tells LyX how paragraphs that are marked with the Section, Subsection,
etc, styles can be translated into corresponding LaTeX, DocBook, and XHTML
commands and tags.
The
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
article.layout
\end_layout
\end_inset
file basically just includes several of these
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
std*.inc
\end_layout
\end_inset
files.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Defining the LyX--LaTeX correspondence is not the only thing layout files
do, though.
Their other job is to define how the LyX constructs themselves will appear
on-screen.
The fact that layout files have these two jobs is often a source of confusion,
because they are completely separate.
Telling LyX how to translate a certain paragraph style into LaTeX does
not tell LyX how to display it; conversely, telling LyX how to display
a certain paragraph style does not tell LyX how to translate it into LaTeX
(let alone tell LaTeX how to display it).
So, in general, when you define a new LyX construct, you must always do
two quite separate things: (i)
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
tell LyX how to translate it into LaTeX and (ii)
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
tell LyX how to display it.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Much the same is true, of course, as regards LyX's other backend formats,
though XHTML is in some ways different, because in that case LyX
\emph on
is
\emph default
able, to some extent, to use information about how it should display a
paragraph on the screen to output information (in the form of CSS) about
how the paragraph should be displayed in a browser.
Even in this case, however, the distinction between what LyX does internally
and how things are rendered externally remains in force, and the two can
be controlled separately.
See
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sec:Tags-for-XHTML"
\end_inset
for the details.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Section
Installing new LaTeX files
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Some installations may not include a LaTeX package or class file that you
would like to use within LyX.
For example, you might need FoilTeX, a package for preparing slides for
overhead projectors.
Modern LaTeX distributions like TeXLive (2008 or newer) or MiKTeX provide
a user interface for installing such packages.
For example, with MiKTeX, you start the program
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Package
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
Manager
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
to get a list of available packages.
To install one of them, right click on it or use the corresponding toolbar
button.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
If your LaTeX distribution does not provide such a `package manager', or
if the package is not available from your distribution, then follow these
steps to install it manually:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Enumerate
Get the package from
\begin_inset CommandInset href
LatexCommand href
name "CTAN"
target "http://www.ctan.org/"
\end_inset
or wherever.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Enumerate
If the package contains a file with the ending
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.ins
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
(is the case for FoilTeX) then open a console, change to the folder of
this file and execute the command
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
latex foiltex.ins
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
You have now unpacked the package and have all files to install it.
Most LaTeX-packages are not packed and you can skip this step.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Enumerate
Now you need to decide if the package should be available for all users
or only for you.
\end_layout
\begin_deeper
\begin_layout Enumerate
On *nix systems (Linux, OSX, etc.), if you want the new package to be available
for all users on your system, then install it in your `local' TeX tree,
otherwise install it in your own `user' TeX tree.
Where these trees should be created, if they do not already exist, depends
on your system.
To find this out, look in the file
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
texmf.cnf
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
This is usually in the directory
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$TEXMF/web2c
\end_layout
\end_inset
, though you can execute the command
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
kpsewhich texmf.cnf
\end_layout
\end_inset
to locate it.
\end_layout
\end_inset
The location of the `local' TeX tree is defined by the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TEXMFLOCAL
\end_layout
\end_inset
variable; this is usually somewhere like
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
/usr/local/share/texmf
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
The location of the `user' TeX tree is defined by
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TEXMFHOME
\end_layout
\end_inset
and is commonly
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$HOME/texmf
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
(If these variables are not predefined, you have to define them.) You'll
probably need root permissions to create or modify the `local' tree, but
not for your `user' tree.
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
In general, it is recommended to install in the user tree because your user
will not be modified or even overwritten when you upgrade your system.
It will typically also be backed up together with everything else when
you backup your home directory (which, of course, you do on a regular basis).
\end_layout
\begin_layout Enumerate
On Windows, if you want the new package to be available for all users on
your system, change to the folder where LaTeX is installed and then change
to the subfolder
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
~
\backslash
tex
\backslash
latex
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
(For MiKTeX, this would be by default the folder
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
~:
\backslash
Programs
\backslash
MiKTeX
\backslash
tex
\backslash
latex
\end_layout
\end_inset
.)
\begin_inset Foot
status open
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Note that this will be the correct path only on English installations.
On a German one, it would be
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
~:
\backslash
Programme
\backslash
MiKTeX
\backslash
tex
\backslash
latex
\end_layout
\end_inset
, and similarly for other languages.
\end_layout
\end_inset
Create there a new folder
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
foiltex
\end_layout
\end_inset
and copy all files of the package into it.
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
If the package should only available for you or you don't have admin permissions
, do the same, but in the local LaTeX folder.
E.
\begin_inset space \thinspace{}
\end_inset
g., for MiKTeX
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
2.8 under Windows XP, this would be the folder:
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
\family sans
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
~:
\backslash
Documents and Settings
\backslash
<username>
\backslash
Application Data
\backslash
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
\family default
\begin_inset Phantom HPhantom
status open
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\family sans
~:
\backslash
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
MiKTeX
\backslash
2.8
\backslash
tex
\backslash
latex
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
On Vista, it would be:
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
~:
\backslash
Users
\backslash
<username>
\backslash
AppData
\backslash
Roaming
\backslash
2.8
\backslash
MiKTeX
\backslash
tex
\backslash
latex
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\end_deeper
\begin_layout Enumerate
Now one only need to tell LaTeX that there are new files.
This depends on the used LaTeX-Distribution:
\end_layout
\begin_deeper
\begin_layout Enumerate
For TeXLive execute the command
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
texhash
\end_layout
\end_inset
from a console.
If you installed the package for all users, then you will probably need
to have root permissions for that.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Enumerate
For MiKTeX, if you have installed the package for all users, start the program
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Settings
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
(Admin)
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
and press the button marked
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Refresh FNDB
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
Otherwise start the program
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Settings
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
and do the same.
\end_layout
\end_deeper
\begin_layout Enumerate
Finally, you need to tell LyX that there are new packages available.
So, in LyX, use the menu
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Tools
\family sans
\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Reconfigure
\end_layout
\end_inset
and then restart LyX.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Now the package is installed.
In our example, the document class
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Slides
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
(FoilTe
\begin_inset ERT
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
{}
\end_layout
\end_inset
x)
\end_layout
\end_inset
will now be available under
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Document\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Settings\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Document Class
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
If you would like to use a LaTeX document class that is not even listed
in the menu
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Document\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Settings\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Document Class
\end_layout
\end_inset
, then you need to create a `layout' file for it.
That is the topic of the next section.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Section
Types of layout files
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
This section describes the various sorts of LyX files that contain layout
information.
These files describe various paragraph and character styles, determining
how LyX should display them and how they should be translated into LaTeX,
DocBook, XHTML, or whatever output format is being used.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
We shall try to provide a thorough description of the process of writing
layout files here.
However, there are so many different types of documents supported even
by just LaTeX that we can't hope to cover every different possibility or
problem you might encounter.
The LyX users' list is frequented by people with lots of experience with
layout design who are willing to share what they've learned, so please
feel free to ask questions there.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
As you prepare to write a new layout, it is extremely helpful to look at
the layouts distributed with LyX.
If you write a LyX layout for a LaTeX document class that might also be
used by others, or write a module that might be useful to others, then
you should consider posting your layout to the
\begin_inset CommandInset href
LatexCommand href
name "layout section on the LyX wiki"
target "http://wiki.lyx.org/Layouts/Layouts"
\end_inset
or even to the LyX developers' list, so that it might be included in LyX
itself.
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Note that LyX is licensed under the General Public License, so any material
that is contributed to LyX must be similarly licensed.
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Layout modules
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sub:Layout-modules"
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
We have spoken to this point about `layout files'.
But there are different sorts of files that contain layout information.
Layout files, strictly so called, have the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.layout
\end_layout
\end_inset
extension and provide LyX with information about document classes.
As of LyX 1.6, however, layout information can also be contained in layout
\emph on
modules
\emph default
, which have the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.module
\end_layout
\end_inset
extension.
Modules are to LaTeX packages much as layouts are to LaTeX classes, and
some modules—such as the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
endnotes
\end_layout
\end_inset
module—specifically provide support for one package.
In a sense, layout modules are similar to included
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
These can have any extension, but by convention have the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.inc
\end_layout
\end_inset
extension.
\end_layout
\end_inset
files—files like
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
stdsections.inc
\end_layout
\end_inset
—in that modules are not specific to a given document class but may be used
with many different classes.
The difference is that using an included file with
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
article.cls
\end_layout
\end_inset
requires editing that file.
Modules, by contrast, are selected in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Document\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Settings
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Building modules is the easiest way to get started with layout editing,
since it can be as simple as adding a single new paragraph style or flex
inset.
But modules may, in principle, contain anything a layout file can contain.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
After creating a new module and copying it to the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
layouts/
\end_layout
\end_inset
folder, you will need to reconfigure and then restart LyX for the module
to appear in the menu.
However, changes you make to the module will be seen immediately, if you
open
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Document\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Settings
\end_layout
\end_inset
, highlight something, and then hit
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
OK
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\emph on
It is strongly recommended that you save your work before doing this
\emph default
.
In fact,
\emph on
it is strongly recommended that you not attempt to edit modules while simultaneo
usly working on actual documents
\emph default
.
Though of course the developers strive to keep LyX stable in such situations,
syntax errors and the like in your module file could cause strange behavior.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsubsection
Local Layout
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Modules are to LyX as packages are to LaTeX.
Sometimes, however, you find yourself wanting a specific inset or character
style just for one document and writing a module that will also be available
to other documents makes little sense.
What you need is LyX's
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Local Layout
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
You will find it under
\family sans
Document\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Settings\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Local Layout
\family default
.
The large text box allows you to enter anything that you might enter in
a layout file or module.
You can think of a document's local layout, in fact, as a module that belongs
just to it.
So, in particular, you must enter a
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Format
\end_layout
\end_inset
tag.
Any format is acceptable, but one would normally use the format current
at the time.
(In LyX 2.0, the current layout format is 35.) You should be aware that local
layout is not supported by versions of LyX prior to 1.6, so you should not
use it if you want to be able to export your document to LyX 1.5 or earlier
(without, that is, losing the local layout information).
If you wish to be able to export to 1.6---local layout is supported in 1.6,
though there is no UI for it---then you should use format 11 and, of course,
use only layout constructs that were available in LyX 1.6.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
When you have entered something in the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Local Layout
\end_layout
\end_inset
pane, LyX will enable the
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Validate
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
button at the bottom.
Clicking this button will cause LyX to determine whether what you have
entered is valid layout information for the chosen format.
LyX will report the result but, unfortunately, will not tell you what errors
there might have been.
These will be written to the terminal, however, if LyX is started from
a terminal.
You will not be permitted to save your local layout until you have entered
something valid.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The warnings at the end of the previous section apply here, too.
Do not play with local layout while you are actually working, especially
if you have not saved your document.
That said, using local layout with a test document can be a very convenient
way to try out layout ideas, or even to start developing a module.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Layout for
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.sty
\end_layout
\end_inset
files
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
There are two situations you are likely to encounter when wanting to support
a new LaTeX document class, involving style (
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.sty
\end_layout
\end_inset
) files and LaTeX2e class (
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.cls
\end_layout
\end_inset
) .
Supporting a style file is usually fairly easy.
Supporting a new class file is a bit harder.
We'll discuss the former in this section and the latter in the next.
Similar remarks apply, of course, if you want to support a new DocBook
DTD.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The easier case is the one in which your new document class is provided
as a style file that is to be used in conjunction with an already supported
document class.
For the sake of the example, we'll assume that the style file is called
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
myclass.sty
\end_layout
\end_inset
and that it is meant to be used with
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
report.cls
\end_layout
\end_inset
, which is a standard class.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Start by copying the existing class's layout file into your local directory:
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Of course, which directory is your local directory will vary by platform,
and LyX allows you to specify your local directory on startup, too, using
the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
-userdir
\end_layout
\end_inset
option.
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
cp report.layout ~/.lyx/layouts/myclass.layout
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Then edit
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
myclass.layout
\end_layout
\end_inset
and change the line:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
DeclareLaTeXClass{report}
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
to read
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
DeclareLaTeXClass[report, myclass.sty]{report (myclass)}
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Then add:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Preamble
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
\backslash
usepackage{myclass}
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
EndPreamble
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
near the top of the file.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Start LyX and select
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Tools\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Reconfigure
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Then restart LyX and try creating a new document.
You should see "
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
report (myclass)
\end_layout
\end_inset
" as a document class option in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Document\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Settings
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog.
It is likely that some of the sectioning commands and such in your new
class will work differently from how they worked in the base class—
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
report
\end_layout
\end_inset
in this example—so you can fiddle around with the settings for the different
sections if you wish.
The layout information for sections is contained in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
stdsections.inc
\end_layout
\end_inset
, but you do not need to copy and change this file.
Instead, you can simply add your changes to your layout file, after the
line
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Input stdclass.inc
\end_layout
\end_inset
, which itself includes
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
stdsections.inc
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
For example, you might add these lines:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Style Chapter
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Font
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Family Sans
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
EndFont
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
End
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
to change the font for chapter headings to sans-serif.
This will override (or, in this case, add to) the existing declaration
for the Chapter style.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Your new package may also provide commands or environments not present in
the base class.
In this case, you will want to add these to the layout file.
See
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sec:TextClass"
\end_inset
for information on how to do so.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
If
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
myclass.sty
\end_layout
\end_inset
can be used with several different document classes, and even if it cannot,
you might find it easiest just to write a module that you can load with
the base class.
The simplest possible such module would be:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
#
\backslash
DeclareLyXModule{My Package}
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
#DescriptionBegin
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
#Support for mypkg.sty.
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
#DescriptionEnd
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Format 21
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Preamble
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
\backslash
usepackage{mypkg}
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
EndPreamble
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
A more complex module might modify the behavior of some existing constructs
or define some new ones.
Again, see
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sec:TextClass"
\end_inset
for discussion.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Layout for
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.cls
\end_layout
\end_inset
files
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
There are two possibilities here.
One is that the class file is itself based upon an existing document class.
For example, many thesis classes are based upon
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
book.cls
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
To see whether yours is, look for a line like
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
LoadClass{book}
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
in the file.
If so, then you may proceed largely as in the previous section, though
the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
DeclareLaTeXClass
\end_layout
\end_inset
line will be different.
If your new class is
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
thesis
\end_layout
\end_inset
and it is based upon
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
book
\end_layout
\end_inset
, then the line should read:
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
And it will be easiest if you save the file to
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
thesis.layout
\end_layout
\end_inset
: LyX assumes that the document class has the same name as the layout file.
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
DeclareLaTeXClass[thesis,book]{thesis}
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
If, on the other hand, the new class is not based upon an existing class,
you will probably have to
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
roll your own
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
layout.
We strongly suggest copying an existing layout file which uses a similar
LaTeX class and then modifying it, if you can do so.
At least use an existing file as a starting point so you can find out what
items you need to worry about.
Again, the specifics are covered below.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Creating templates
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sub:Creating-Templates"
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Once you have written a layout file for a new document class, you might
want to consider writing a
\emph on
template
\emph default
for it, too.
A template acts as a kind of tutorial for your layout, showing how it might
be used, though containing dummy content.
You can of course look at the various templates included with LyX for ideas.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Templates are created just like usual documents: using LyX.
The only difference is that usual documents contain all possible settings,
including the font scheme and the paper size.
Usually a user doesn't want a template to overwrite his preferred settings
for such parameters.
For that reason, the designer of a template should remove the corresponding
commands like
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
font_roman
\end_layout
\end_inset
or
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
papersize
\end_layout
\end_inset
from the template LyX file.
This can be done with any simple text-editor, for example
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
vi
\end_layout
\end_inset
or
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
notepad
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Put the edited template files you create in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UserDir/templates/
\end_layout
\end_inset
, copy the ones you use from the global template directory in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LyXDir/templates/
\end_layout
\end_inset
to the same place, and redefine the template path in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Tools\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Preferences\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Paths
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Note, by the way, that there is a template which has a particular meaning:
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
defaults.lyx
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
This template is loaded every time you create a new document with
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
File\SpecialChar \menuseparator
New
\end_layout
\end_inset
in order to provide useful defaults.
To create this template from inside LyX, all you have to do is to open
a document with the correct settings, and use the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Save as Document Defaults
\end_layout
\end_inset
button.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Upgrading old layout files
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The format of layout files changes with each LyX release, so old layout
files need to be converted to the new format.
This process has been automated since LyX 1.4: If LyX reads a layout file
in an older format, it automatically calls the script
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
layout2layout.py
\end_layout
\end_inset
to convert it to a temporary file in current format.
The original file is left untouched.
If you use the layout file often, then, you may want to convert it permanently,
so that LyX does not have to do so itself every time.
To do this, you can call the converter manually:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
mv myclass.layout myclass.old
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
python LyXDir/scripts/layout2layout.py myclass.old myclass.layout
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
You need to replace
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LyXDir
\end_layout
\end_inset
with the name of your LyX system directory, of course.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Note that manual conversion does not affect included files, so these will
have to be converted separately.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Section
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sec:TextClass"
\end_inset
The layout file format
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
When it's finally time to get your hands dirty and create or edit your own
layout file, the following sections describe what you're up against.
Our advice is to go slowly, save and test often, listen to soothing music,
and enjoy one or two of your favorite adult beverages; more if you are
getting particularly stuck.
It's really not that hard, except that the multitude of options can become
overwhelming if you try to do too much in one sitting.
Go have another adult beverage, just for good measure.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Note that all the tags used in layout files are case-insensitive.
This means that
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Style
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
style
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
StYlE
\end_layout
\end_inset
are really the same tag.
The possible values are printed in brackets after the feature's name.
The default value if a feature isn't specified inside a text class-description
is typeset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
emphasized
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
If the argument has a data type like
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
string
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
or
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
float
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
, the default is shown like this:
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
float=
\emph on
default
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
The document class declaration
2012-10-09 07:29:02 +00:00
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766602
and classification
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Lines in a layout file which begin with
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
#
\end_layout
\end_inset
are comments.
There is one exception to this rule.
All
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
*.layout
\end_layout
\end_inset
2012-10-09 07:29:02 +00:00
files should begin with
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766533
a
\change_unchanged
line
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766536
s
\change_unchanged
like:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\size small
#% Do not delete the line below; configure depends on this
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\size small
#
\backslash
2012-10-09 07:29:02 +00:00
DeclareLaTeXClass{
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766193
article
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766201
Article (Standard Class)
\change_unchanged
}
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766538
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766581
\size small
#
\backslash
DeclareCategory{Articles}
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
2012-10-09 07:29:02 +00:00
The second
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766695
and third
\change_unchanged
line
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766626
s
\change_unchanged
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766628
is
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766628
are
\change_unchanged
used when you (re)configure LyX.
The layout file is read by the LaTeX script
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
chkconfig.ltx
\end_layout
\end_inset
, in a special mode where
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
#
\end_layout
\end_inset
is ignored.
2012-10-09 07:29:02 +00:00
The first line is just a LaTeX comment,
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766656
and
\change_unchanged
the second one contains the
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766650
mandatory
\change_unchanged
declaration of the text class
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766689
, and the third line contains the optional classification of the class
\change_unchanged
.
If these lines appear in a file named
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
article.layout
\end_layout
\end_inset
, then they define a text class of name
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
article
\end_layout
\end_inset
(the name of the layout file) which uses the LaTeX document class
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
article.cls
\end_layout
\end_inset
(the default is to use the same name as the layout).
The string
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
2012-10-09 07:29:02 +00:00
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766253
article
2012-10-09 07:29:02 +00:00
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766260
Article (Standard Class)
\change_unchanged
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
that appears above is used as a description of the text class in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Document\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Settings
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog.
2012-10-09 07:29:02 +00:00
\change_inserted -712698321 1349767097
The category (
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Articles
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
in the example) is also used in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766801
Document\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Settings
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog: the text classes are grouped by these categories (which are usually
genres, so typical categories are
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Articles
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Books
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Reports
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Letters
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Presentations
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Curricula Vitae
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
etc.).
If no category has been declared, the class will be put in the
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Uncategorized
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
group.
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Let's assume that you wrote your own text class that uses the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
article.cls
\end_layout
\end_inset
document class, but where you changed the appearance of the section headings.
If you put it in a file
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
myarticle.layout
\end_layout
\end_inset
, the header of this file should be:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\size small
#% Do not delete the line below; configure depends on this
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\size small
#
\backslash
2012-10-09 07:29:02 +00:00
DeclareLaTeXClass[article]{
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766303
a
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766303
A
\change_unchanged
rticle (with
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766338
m
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766338
M
\change_unchanged
y
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766340
o
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766340
O
\change_unchanged
wn
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766343
h
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766343
H
\change_unchanged
eadings)}
\change_inserted -712698321 1349767223
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\change_inserted -712698321 1349767223
\size small
#
\backslash
DeclareCategory{Articles}
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
This declares a text class
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
myarticle
\end_layout
\end_inset
, associated with the LaTeX document class
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
article.cls
\end_layout
\end_inset
and described as
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
2012-10-09 07:29:02 +00:00
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766329
a
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766329
A
\change_unchanged
rticle (with
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766347
m
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766347
M
\change_unchanged
y
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766350
o
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766350
O
\change_unchanged
wn
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766352
h
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766352
H
\change_unchanged
eadings)
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
If your text class depends on several packages, you can declare it as:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\size small
#% Do not delete the line below; configure depends on this
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\size small
#
\backslash
2012-10-09 07:29:02 +00:00
DeclareLaTeXClass[article,foo.sty]{
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766366
a
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766366
A
\change_unchanged
rticle (with
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766369
m
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766369
M
\change_unchanged
y
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766371
o
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766371
O
\change_unchanged
wn
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766374
h
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766374
H
\change_unchanged
eadings)}
\change_inserted -712698321 1349767240
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\change_inserted -712698321 1349767240
\size small
#
\backslash
DeclareCategory{Articles}
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
This indicates that your text class uses the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
foo.sty
\end_layout
\end_inset
package.
Finally, it is also possible to declare classes for DocBook code.
Typical declarations will look like:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\size small
#% Do not delete the line below; configure depends on this
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\size small
#
\backslash
2012-10-09 07:29:02 +00:00
DeclareDocBookClass[article]{SGML (DocBook
\change_deleted -712698321 1349766387
a
\change_inserted -712698321 1349766387
A
\change_unchanged
rticle)}
\change_inserted -712698321 1349767247
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\change_inserted -712698321 1349767302
\size small
#
\backslash
DeclareCategory{Articles (DocBook)}
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Note that these declarations can also be given an optional parameter declaring
the name of the document class (but not a list).
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
So, to be as explicit as possible, the form of the layout declaration is:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\size small
#
\backslash
DeclareLaTeXClass[class,package.sty]{layout description}
2012-10-09 07:29:02 +00:00
\change_inserted -712698321 1349767329
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\change_inserted -712698321 1349767339
\size small
#
\backslash
DeclareCategory{category}
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The class need only be specified if the name of the LaTeX class file and
the name of the layout file are different or if there are packages to load.
If the name of the class file is not specified, then LyX will simply assume
that it is the same as the name of the layout file.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
When the text class has been modified to your taste, all you have to do
is to copy it either to
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LyXDir/layouts/
\end_layout
\end_inset
or to
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UserDir/layouts
\end_layout
\end_inset
, run
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Tools\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Reconfigure
\end_layout
\end_inset
, exit LyX and restart.
Then your new text class should be available along with the others.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Once the layout file is installed, you can edit it and see your changes
without having to reconfigure or to restart LyX.
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
In versions of LyX prior to 1.6, this was not true.
As a result, editing layout files was very time consuming, since you had
constantly to restart LyX to see changes.
\end_layout
\end_inset
You can force a reload of the current layout by using the LyX function
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
layout-reload
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
There is no default binding for this function—though, of course, you can
bind it to a key yourself.
But you will normally use this function simply by entering it in the mini-buffe
r.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
\emph on
Warning
\emph default
:
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
layout-reload
\end_layout
\end_inset
is very much an `advanced feature'.
It is
\emph on
strongly
\emph default
recommended that you save your work before using this function.
In fact, it is
\emph on
strongly
\emph default
recommended that you not attempt to edit layout information while simultaneousl
y working on a document that you care about.
Use a test document.
Syntax errors and the like in your layout file could cause peculiar behavior.
In particular, such errors could cause LyX to regard the current layout
as invalid and to attempt to switch to some other layout.
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Really bad syntax errors may even caused LyX to exit.
This is because certain sorts of errors may make LyX unable to read
\emph on
any
\emph default
layout information.
Please be careful.
\end_layout
\end_inset
The LyX team strives to keep LyX stable in such situations, but safe is
better than sorry.
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
While we're giving advice: make regular backups.
And be nice to your mother.
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
The Module declaration
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
A module must begin with a line like the following:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
#
\backslash
DeclareLyXModule[endnotes.sty]{Endnotes}
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The mandatory argument, in curly brackets, is the name of the module, as
it should appear in
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Document\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Settings\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Modules
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
The argument in square brackets is optional: It declares any LaTeX packages
on which the module depends.
Please note that only packages about which LyX knows should be listed in
the square brackets.
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
The list of such packages is documented only in the source code.
\end_layout
\end_inset
LyX will not check for arbitrary packages.
It is also possible to use the form
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
from->to
\end_layout
\end_inset
as an optional argument, which declares that the module can only be used
when there exists a conversion chain between the formats `
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
from
\end_layout
\end_inset
' and `
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
to
\end_layout
\end_inset
'.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The module declaration should then be followed by lines like the following
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Preferably in English if the module should be published with LyX.
This description will appear in the list of messages to be translated and
will be thus translated with the next interface update.
\end_layout
\end_inset
:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
#DescriptionBegin
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
#Adds an endnote command, in addition to footnotes.
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
#You will need to add
\backslash
theendnotes in TeX code where you
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
#want the endnotes to appear.
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
#DescriptionEnd
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
#Requires: somemodule | othermodule
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
#Excludes: badmodule
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The description is used in
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Document\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Settings\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Modules
\end_layout
\end_inset
to provide the user with information about what the module does.
The
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Requires
\end_layout
\end_inset
line is used to identify other modules with which this one must be used;
the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Excludes
\end_layout
\end_inset
line is used to identify modules with which this one may not be used.
Both are optional, and, as shown, multiple modules should be separated
with the pipe symbol: |.
Note that the required modules are treated disjunctively:
\emph on
at least one
\emph default
of the required modules must be used.
Similarly,
\emph on
no
\emph default
excluded module may be used.
Note that modules are identified here by their
\emph on
filenames
\emph default
without the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.module
\end_layout
\end_inset
extension.
So
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
somemodule
\end_layout
\end_inset
is really
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
somemodule.module
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Format number
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The first non-comment line of any layout file, included file, or module
\emph on
must
\emph default
contain the file format number:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Format
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
int
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The format of the layout file.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
This tag was introduced with LyX 1.4.0.
Layout files from LyX 1.3.x and earlier don't have an explicit file format
and are considered to be of format 1.
The format for the present version of LyX is format 21.
But each version of LyX is capable of reading earlier versions' layout
files, just as they are capable of reading files produced by earlier versions
of LyX.
There is, however, no provision for converting to earlier formats.
So LyX 1.6.x will not read layout files in format 21 but only files in format
11 or earlier.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sub:General-text-class"
\end_inset
General text class parameters
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
These are general parameters that govern the behavior of an entire document
class.
(This does
\emph on
not
\emph default
mean that they must appear in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.layout
\end_layout
\end_inset
files rather than in modules.
A module can contain any layout tag.)
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
AddToHTMLPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
Adds information that will be output in the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<head>
\end_layout
\end_inset
block when this document class is output to XHTML.
Typically, this would be used to output CSS style information, but it can
be used for anything that can appear in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<head>
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
EndPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
AddToHTMLStyles
\end_layout
\end_inset
Adds CSS styling information.
This will either be output in a
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<style>
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
block or, if the user has so chosen, to a separate CSS file.Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
EndStyles
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
AddToPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
Adds information to the document preamble.
Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
EndPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
CiteFormat
\end_layout
\end_inset
Defines formats for use in the display of bibliographic information.
See Section
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Citation-format-description"
\end_inset
for details.
Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
End
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ClassOptions
\end_layout
\end_inset
Describes various global options supported by the document class.
See Section
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:ClassOptions"
\end_inset
for a description.
Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
End
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Columns
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
2
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether the class should
\emph on
default
\emph default
to having one or two columns.
Can be changed in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Document\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Settings
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Counter
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] This sequence defines the properties for a counter.
If the counter does not yet exist, it is created; if it does exist, it
is modified.
Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
End
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
See Section
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Counters"
\end_inset
for details on counters.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
DefaultFont
\end_layout
\end_inset
Sets the default font used to display the document.
See Section
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Font-description"
\end_inset
for how to declare fonts.
Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
EndFont
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
DefaultModule
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string]
\end_layout
\end_inset
Specifies a module to be included by default with this document class.
The module should be specified by filename without the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.module
\end_layout
\end_inset
extension.
The user can still remove the module, but it will be active at the outset.
(This applies only when new files are created, or when this class is chosen
for an existing document.)
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
DefaultStyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] This is the style that will be assigned to new paragraphs, usually
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Standard
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
This will default to the first defined style if not given, but you are
encouraged to use this directive.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ExcludesModule
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] This tag indicates that the module in question—which should be specified
by filename without the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.module
\end_layout
\end_inset
extension—cannot be used with this document class.
This might be used in a journal-specific layout file to prevent, say, the
use of the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
theorems-sec
\end_layout
\end_inset
module that numbers theorems by section.
This tag may
\emph on
not
\emph default
be used in a module.
Modules have their own way of excluding other modules (see
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Layout-modules"
\end_inset
).
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Float
\end_layout
\end_inset
Defines a new float.
See Section
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Floats"
\end_inset
for details.
Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
End
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
Sets the information that will be output in the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<head>
\end_layout
\end_inset
block when this document class is output to XHTML.
Note that this will completely override any prior
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
or
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
AddToHTMLPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
declarations.
(Use
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
AddToHTMLPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
if you just want to add material to the preamble.) Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
EndPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLStyles
\end_layout
\end_inset
Sets CSS styling information.
This will either be output in a
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<style>
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
block or, if the user has so chosen, to a separate CSS file.
Note that this will completely override any prior
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLStyles
\end_layout
\end_inset
or
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
AddToHTMLStyles
\end_layout
\end_inset
declarations.
(Use
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
AddToHTMLStyles
\end_layout
\end_inset
if you just want to add material.) Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
EndStyles
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLTOCSection
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The layout to use for the table of contents, bibliography, and so forth,
when the document is output to HTML.
For articles, this should normally be Section; for books, Chapter.
If it is not given, then LyX will attempt to figure out which layout to
use.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
IfCounter
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Modifies the properties of the given counter.
If the counter does not exist, the section is ignored.
Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
End
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
See Section
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Counters"
\end_inset
for details on counters.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
IfStyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Modifies the properties of the given paragraph style.
If the style does not exist, the section is ignored.
Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
End
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Input
\end_layout
\end_inset
As its name implies, this command allows you to include another layout
definition file within yours to avoid duplicating commands.
Common examples are the standard layout files, for example,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
stdclass.inc
\end_layout
\end_inset
, which contains most of the basic layouts.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
InsetLayout
\end_layout
\end_inset
This section (re-)defines the layout of an inset.
It can be applied to an existing inset or to a new, user-defined inset,
e.g., a new character style.
Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
End
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
See Section
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Flex-insets-and"
\end_inset
for more information.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LeftMargin
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] A string that indicates the width of the left margin on the screen, for
example,
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
MMMMM
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
(Note that this is not a `length', like
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
2ex
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.)
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
NoCounter
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] This command deletes an existing counter, usually one defined in an included
file.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
NoFloat
\end_layout
\end_inset
This command deletes an existing float.
This is particularly useful when you want to suppress a float that has
been defined in an input file.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
NoStyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
This command deletes an existing style.
This is particularly useful when you want to suppress a style that has
be defined in an input file.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
OutputFormat
\end_layout
\end_inset
A string indicating the file format (as defined in the Preferences dialog)
produced by this class.
It is mainly useful when
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
OutputType
\end_layout
\end_inset
is `literate' and one wants to define a new type of literate document.
This string is reset to `docbook', `latex', or `literate' when the correspondin
g
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
OutputType
\end_layout
\end_inset
parameter is encountered.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
OutputType
\end_layout
\end_inset
A string indicating what sort of output documents using this class will
produce.
At present, the options are: `docbook', `latex', and `literate'.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
PageStyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
plain
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
empty
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
headings
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The default pagestyle.
Can be changed in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Document\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Settings
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Preamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
Sets the preamble for the LaTeX document.
Note that this will completely override any prior
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Preamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
or
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
AddToPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
declarations.
(Use
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
AddToPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
if you just want to add material to the preamble.) Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
EndPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Provides
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] [
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether the class already provides the feature
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
A feature is in general the name of a package (
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
amsmath
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
makeidx
\end_layout
\end_inset
, \SpecialChar \ldots{}
) or a macro (
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
url
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
boldsymbol
\end_layout
\end_inset
,\SpecialChar \ldots{}
); the complete list of supported features is unfortunately not documented
outside the LyX source code—but see
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LaTeXFeatures.cpp
\end_layout
\end_inset
if you're interested.
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Help\SpecialChar \menuseparator
LaTeX Configuration
\end_layout
\end_inset
also gives an overview of the supported packages.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ProvidesModule
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Indicates that this layout provides the functionality of the module mentioned,
which should be specified by the filename without the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.module
\end_layout
\end_inset
extension.
This will typically be used if the layout includes the module directly,
rather than using the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
DefaultModule
\end_layout
\end_inset
tag to indicate that it ought to be used.
It could also be used in a module that provided an alternate implementation
of the same functionality.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Requires
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether the class requires the feature
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Multiple features must be separated by commas.
Note that you can only request supported features.
(Again, see
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LaTeXFeatures.cpp
\end_layout
\end_inset
for a list of these.)
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
RightMargin
\end_layout
\end_inset
A string that indicates the width of the right margin on the screen, for
example,
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
MMMMM
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
SecNumDepth
\end_layout
\end_inset
Sets which divisions get numbered.
Corresponds to the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
secnumdepth
\end_layout
\end_inset
counter in LaTeX.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Sides
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
2
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether the class-default should be printing on one or both sides of the
paper.
Can be changed in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Document\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Settings
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Style
\end_layout
\end_inset
This sequence defines a paragraph style.
If the style does not yet exist, it is created; if it does exist, its parameter
s are modified.
Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
End
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
See Section
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Paragraph-Styles"
\end_inset
for details on paragraph styles.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TitleLatexName
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string="maketitle"
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The name of the command or environment to be used with
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TitleLatexType
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TitleLatexType
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
CommandAfter
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Indicates what kind of markup is used to define the title of a document.
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
CommandAfter
\end_layout
\end_inset
means that the macro with name
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TitleLatexName
\end_layout
\end_inset
will be inserted after the last layout which has
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
InTitle 1
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
corresponds to the case where the block of paragraphs which have
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
InTitle 1
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
should be enclosed into the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TitleLatexName
\end_layout
\end_inset
environment.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TocDepth
\end_layout
\end_inset
Sets which divisions are included in the table of contents.
Corresponds to the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
tocdepth
\end_layout
\end_inset
counter in LaTeX.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ClassOptions
\end_layout
\end_inset
section
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sub:ClassOptions"
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ClassOptions
\end_layout
\end_inset
section can contain the following entries:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
FontSize
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string="10|11|12"
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The list of available font sizes for the document's main font, separated
by
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
|
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Header
\end_layout
\end_inset
Used to set the DTD line with XML-based output classes.
E.
\begin_inset space \thinspace{}
\end_inset
g.: PUBLIC
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.2//EN
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
PageStyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string="empty|plain|headings|fancy"
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The list of available page styles, separated by
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
|
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Other
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string=""
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Some document class options, separated by a comma, that will be added
to the optional part of the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
documentclass
\end_layout
\end_inset
command.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ClassOptions
\end_layout
\end_inset
section must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
End
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Paragraph styles
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sub:Paragraph-Styles"
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
A paragraph style description looks like this:
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Note that this will either define a new style or modify an existing one.
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Style
\family roman
\emph on
name
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
...
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
End
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
where the following commands are allowed:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Align
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
block
\emph default
, left, right, center
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Paragraph alignment.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
AlignPossible
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
block
\emph default
, left, right, center
\end_layout
\end_inset
] A comma separated list of permitted alignments.
(Some LaTeX styles prohibit certain alignments, since those wouldn't make
sense.
For example a right-aligned or centered enumeration isn't possible.)
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\change_inserted -712698321 1353679769
\end_layout
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\begin_layout Description
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680268
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353679781
Argument
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353679772
int
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Defines argument number <int> of a command\SpecialChar \slash{}
environment associated with
the current style.
This is useful for things like section headings, and only makes sense with
LaTeX.
Every (optional or required) argument of a command or environment -- except
for the required argument that is associated with the content of the paragraph
itself -- has a separate definition, where the number specifies the order
of the arguments.
The definition must end with
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680069
EndArgument
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
So a command with two optional arguments has:
\end_layout
\begin_deeper
\begin_layout Quote
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680127
\family typewriter
Argument 1
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quote
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680195
\family typewriter
...
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quote
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680135
\family typewriter
EndArgument
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quote
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680140
\family typewriter
Argument 2
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quote
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680197
\family typewriter
...
\end_layout
\begin_layout Quote
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680147
\family typewriter
EndArgument
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680528
Inside the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680412
Argument
\end_layout
\end_inset
definition, the following specifications are possible:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\change_inserted -712698321 1353691469
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680543
LabelString
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680567
[string]
\end_layout
\end_inset
The string that will appear both in the menu (to insert this argument)
and on the argument inset button.
For the menu, you can define an accelerator by appending the respective
character to the string, divided by
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
|
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
(e.
\begin_inset space \thinspace{}
\end_inset
g.
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353691482
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
Short Title|S
\begin_inset Quotes erd
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\end_inset
\change_unchanged
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\end_layout
\end_inset
).
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680665
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680616
Tooltip
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680623
[string]
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\end_layout
\end_inset
A longer explanatory text that appears in the tooltip when hovering over
the argument inset.
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680874
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680732
Mandatory
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680738
[int=0]
\end_layout
\end_inset
2012-11-24 16:14:06 +00:00
Declare if this is a mandatory
\change_inserted 2090807402 1353765594
(1)
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680874
or an optional
\change_inserted 2090807402 1353765599
(0)
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680874
argument.
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
Mandatory arguments will be output empty if not given, while optional arguments
will not be output at all.
By default, mandatory arguments are delimited by
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680808
{...}
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
, while optional arguments are delimited by
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680833
[...]
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\change_inserted -712698321 1353681232
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680879
Requires
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353680874
[int=0]
\end_layout
\end_inset
defines another argument (by its number) which this argument requires to
be output if it is itself output.
E.
\begin_inset space \thinspace{}
\end_inset
g., in LaTeX commands, optional arguments often require previous optional
arguments to be output (at least empty), as in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
2012-11-23 16:30:45 +00:00
\change_inserted -712698321 1353688183
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\backslash
2012-11-23 16:30:45 +00:00
command[][arg]{text}
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
This can be achieved by the statement
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353681031
Requires 1
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
within
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353681045
Argument 2
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\change_inserted -712698321 1353681145
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353681072
LeftDelim
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353681067
[string]
\end_layout
\end_inset
defines a custom left delimiter (instead of
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353681127
{
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
or
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353681133
[
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
).
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\change_inserted -712698321 1353681155
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353681149
RightDelim
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353681146
[string]
\end_layout
\end_inset
defines a custom right delimiter (instead of
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353681158
}
\end_layout
\end_inset
or
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353681161
]
\end_layout
\end_inset
).
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_deeper
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
BabelPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
Note that this will completely override any prior
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
BabelPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
declaration for this style.
Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
EndBabelPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
See section
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:I18n"
\end_inset
for details on its use.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
BottomSep
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
float=0
\end_layout
\end_inset
]
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Note that a `float' here is a real number, such as: 1.5.
\end_layout
\end_inset
The vertical space with which the last of a chain of paragraphs with this
style is separated from the following paragraph.
If the next paragraph has another style, the separations are not simply
added, but the maximum is taken.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Category
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
[string]
\end_layout
\end_inset
The category for this style.
This is used to group related styles in the style combobox on the toolbar.
Any string can be used, but you may want to use existing categories with
your own styles.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
CommandDepth
\end_layout
\end_inset
Depth of XML command.
Used only with XML-type formats.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
CopyStyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
[string]
\end_layout
\end_inset
Copies all the features of an existing style into the current one.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
DependsOn
\end_layout
\end_inset
The name of a style whose preamble should be output
\emph on
before
\emph default
this one.
This allows to ensure some ordering of the preamble snippets when macros
definitions depend on one another.
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Note that, besides that functionality, there is no way to ensure any ordering
of preambles.
The ordering that you see in a given version of LyX may change without
warning in later versions.
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
EndLabeltype
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
No_Label
\emph default
, Box, Filled_Box, Static
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The type of label that stands at the end of the paragraph (or sequence
of paragraphs if
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LatexType
\end_layout
\end_inset
is
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Item_Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
or
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
List_Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
).
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
No_Label
\end_layout
\end_inset
means
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
nothing
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Box
\end_layout
\end_inset
(resp.
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
Filled_Box
\end_layout
\end_inset
) is a white (resp.
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
black) square suitable for end of proof markers,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Static
\end_layout
\end_inset
is an explicit text string.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
EndLabelString
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string=""
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The string used for a label with a
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Static
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
EndLabelType
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Font
\end_layout
\end_inset
The font used for both the text body
\emph on
and
\emph default
the label.
See section
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Font-description"
\end_inset
.
Note that defining this font automatically defines the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelFont
\end_layout
\end_inset
to the same value.
So you should define this one first if you also want to define
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelFont
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
FreeSpacing
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "des:FreeSpacing"
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Usually LyX doesn't allow you to insert more than one space between words,
since a space is considered as the separation between two words, not a
character or symbol of its own.
This is a very fine thing but sometimes annoying, for example, when typing
program code or plain LaTeX code.
For this reason,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
FreeSpacing
\end_layout
\end_inset
can be enabled.
Note that LyX will create protected blanks for the additional blanks when
in another mode than LaTeX-mode.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTML*
\end_layout
\end_inset
These tags are used with XHTML output.
See
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Paragraph-Style-XHTML"
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
InnerTag
\end_layout
\end_inset
[[FIXME]] (Used only with XML-type formats.)
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
InPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
[1, 0]
\end_layout
\end_inset
If 1, marks the style as to be included in the document preamble rather
than in the document body.
This is useful for document classes that want such information as the title
and author to appear in the preamble.
Note that this works only for styles for which the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LatexType
\end_layout
\end_inset
is
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Command
\end_layout
\end_inset
or
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Paragraph
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
InTitle
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
[1, 0]
\end_layout
\end_inset
If 1, marks the style as being part of a title block (see also the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TitleLatexType
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TitleLatexName
\end_layout
\end_inset
global entries).
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ItemSep
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
float=0
\end_layout
\end_inset
] This provides extra space between paragraphs that have the same style.
If you put other styles into an environment, each is separated with the
environment's
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Parsep
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
But the whole items of the environment are additionally separated with
this
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Itemsep
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Note that this is a
\emph on
multiplier.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ItemTag
\end_layout
\end_inset
[[FIXME]] (Used only with XML-type formats.)
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
KeepEmpty
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Usually LyX does not allow you to leave a paragraph empty, since it would
lead to empty LaTeX output.
There are some cases where this could be desirable however: in a letter
template, the required fields can be provided as empty fields, so that
people do not forget them; in some special classes, a style can be used
as some kind of break, which does not contain actual text.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelBottomsep
\end_layout
\end_inset
[float=0] The vertical space between the label and the text body.
Only used for labels that are above the text body (
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Top_Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Centered_Top_Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
).
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelCounter
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string=""
\end_layout
\end_inset
]
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
The name of the counter for automatic numbering.
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
This
\emph on
must
\emph default
be given if
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelType
\end_layout
\end_inset
is
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Counter
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
In that case, the counter will be stepped each time the style appears.
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
This
\emph on
may
\emph default
also be given if
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelType
\end_layout
\end_inset
is
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Enumerate
\end_layout
\end_inset
, though this case is a bit complicated.
Suppose you declare
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelCounter myenum
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
Then the actual counters used are
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
myenumi
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
myenumii
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
myenumiii
\end_layout
\end_inset
, and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
myenumiv
\end_layout
\end_inset
, much as in LaTeX.
These counters must all be declared separately.
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
See Section
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Counters"
\end_inset
for details on counters.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelFont
\end_layout
\end_inset
The font used for the label.
See section
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Font-description"
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelIndent
\end_layout
\end_inset
Text that indicates how far a label should be indented.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Labelsep
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string=""
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The horizontal space between the label and the text body.
Only used for labels that are not above the text body.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelString
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string=""
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The string used for a label with a
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Static
\end_layout
\end_inset
labeltype.
When
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelCounter
\end_layout
\end_inset
is set, this string can be contain the special formatting commands described
in Section
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Counters"
\end_inset
.
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
For the sake of backwards compatibility, the string
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
@
\emph on
style-name
\emph default
@
\end_layout
\end_inset
will be replaced by the expanded
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelString
\end_layout
\end_inset
of style
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
style-name
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
This feature is now obsolete and should be replaced by the mechanisms of
Section
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Counters"
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelStringAppendix
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string=""
\end_layout
\end_inset
] This is used inside the appendix instead of
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelString
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Note that every
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelString
\end_layout
\end_inset
statement resets
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelStringAppendix
\end_layout
\end_inset
too.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelTag
\end_layout
\end_inset
[FIXME] (Used only with XML-type formats.)
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelType
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
No_Label
\emph default
, Manual, Static, Top_Environment, Centered_Top_Environment, Counter, Sensitive,
Enumerate, Itemize, Bibliography
\end_layout
\end_inset
]
\end_layout
\begin_deeper
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Manual
\end_layout
\end_inset
means the label is the very first word (up to the first real blank).
Use protected spaces (like
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
that one) if you want more than one word as the label.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Static
\end_layout
\end_inset
means the label is simply whatever
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelString
\end_layout
\end_inset
declares it to be.
Note that this really is `static'.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Top_Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Centered_Top_Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
are special cases of
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Static
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
The label will be printed above the paragraph, but only at the top of an
environment or the top of a chain of paragraphs with this style.
This might be used with the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Abstract
\end_layout
\end_inset
style, for example.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Sensitive
\end_layout
\end_inset
is a special case for the caption-labels
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Figure
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Table
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Sensitive
\end_layout
\end_inset
means the (hardcoded) label string depends on the kind of float: It is
hardcoded to be `FloatType N', where N is the value of the counter associated
with the float.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
The
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Counter
\end_layout
\end_inset
label type defines automatically numbered labels.
The
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelString
\end_layout
\end_inset
will be expanded to resolve any counter references it contains: For example,
it might be
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Section
\backslash
thechapter.
\backslash
thesection
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
See Section
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Counters"
\end_inset
for more information on counters.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Enumerate
\end_layout
\end_inset
produces the usual sort of enumeration labels.
At present, it is hardcoded to use Arabic numerals, lowercase letters,
small Roman numerals, and uppercase letters for the four possible depths.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Itemize
\end_layout
\end_inset
produces various bullets at the different levels.
It is also hardcoded.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Bibliography
\end_layout
\end_inset
is used internally by LyX and should be used only with
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LatexType BibEnvironment
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\end_deeper
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LangPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
Note that this will completely override any prior
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LangPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
declaration for this style.
Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
EndLangPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
See section
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:I18n"
\end_inset
for details on its use.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LatexName
\end_layout
\end_inset
The name of the corresponding LaTeX stuff.
Either the environment or command name.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LatexParam
\end_layout
\end_inset
An optional parameter for the corresponding
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LatexName
\end_layout
\end_inset
stuff.
This parameter cannot be changed from within LyX.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LatexType
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
Paragraph
\emph default
, Command, Environment, Item_Environment,
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
List_Environment, Bib_Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
] How the style should be translated into LaTeX.
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LatexType
\end_layout
\end_inset
is perhaps a bit misleading, since these rules apply to SGML classes, too.
Visit the SGML class files for specific examples.
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_deeper
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Paragraph
\end_layout
\end_inset
means nothing special.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Command
\end_layout
\end_inset
means
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
\emph on
LatexName
\emph default
{\SpecialChar \ldots{}
}
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
means
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
begin{
\emph on
LatexName
\emph default
}\SpecialChar \ldots{}
\backslash
end{
\emph on
LatexName
\emph default
}
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Item_Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
is the same as
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
, except that an
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
item
\end_layout
\end_inset
is generated for each paragraph of this environment.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
List_Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
is the same as
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Item_Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
, except that
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelWidthString
\end_layout
\end_inset
is passed as an argument to the environment.
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelWidthString
\end_layout
\end_inset
can be defined in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Edit\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Paragraph
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
settings
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Putting the last few things together, the LaTeX output will be either:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
latexname[latexparam]{\SpecialChar \ldots{}
}
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
or:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
begin{latexname}[latexparam] \SpecialChar \ldots{}
\backslash
end{latexname}.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
depending upon the LaTeX type.
\end_layout
\end_deeper
\begin_layout Description
\change_inserted -712698321 1353866861
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353866852
LeftDelim
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353866852
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] A string that is put at the beginning of the style content.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LeftMargin
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string=""
\end_layout
\end_inset
] If you put styles into environments, the leftmargins are not simply added,
but added with a factor
\begin_inset Formula $\frac{4}{depth+4}$
\end_inset
.
Note that this parameter is also used when the margin is defined as
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Manual
\end_layout
\end_inset
or
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Dynamic
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Then it is added to the manual or dynamic margin.
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
The argument is passed as a string.
For example
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
MM
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
means that the paragraph is indented with the width of
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
MM
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
in the normal font.
You can get a negative width by prefixing the string with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
-
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
This way was chosen so that the look is the same with each used screen
font.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Margin
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
Static
\emph default
, Manual, Dynamic, First_Dynamic, Right_Address_Box
\end_layout
\end_inset
]
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
The kind of margin that the style has on the left side.
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Static
\end_layout
\end_inset
just means a fixed margin.
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Manual
\end_layout
\end_inset
means that the left margin depends on the string entered in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Edit\SpecialChar \menuseparator
Paragraph
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
Settings
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog.
This is used to typeset nice lists without tabulators.
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Dynamic
\end_layout
\end_inset
means that the margin depends on the size of the label.
This is used for automatic enumerated headlines.
It is obvious that the headline
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
5.4.3.2.1 Very long headline
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
must have a wider left margin (as wide as
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
5.4.3.2.1
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
plus the space) than
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
3.2 Very long headline
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
, even if standard
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
word processors
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
are not able to do this.
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
First_Dynamic
\end_layout
\end_inset
is similar, but only the very first row of the paragraph is dynamic, while
the others are static; this is used, for example, for descriptions.
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Right_Address_Box
\end_layout
\end_inset
means the margin is chosen in a way that the longest row of this paragraph
fits to the right margin.
This is used to typeset an address on the right edge of the page.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
NeedProtect
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether fragile commands in this style should be
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
protect
\end_layout
\end_inset
'ed.
(Note: This is
\emph on
not
\emph default
whether this command should itself be protected.)
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Newline
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether newlines are translated into LaTeX newlines (
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
\backslash
\end_layout
\end_inset
) or not.
The translation can be switched off to allow more comfortable LaTeX editing
inside LyX.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
NextNoIndent
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
] If set to true, and if
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
DefaultStyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
(usually
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Standard
\end_layout
\end_inset
) paragraphs are being indented, then the indentation of such a paragraph
following one of this type will be suppressed.
(So this will not affect the display of non-default paragraphs.)
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ObsoletedBy
\end_layout
\end_inset
Name of a style that has replaced this style.
This is used to rename a style, while keeping backward compatibility.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\change_deleted -712698321 1353679722
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
OptionalArgs
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
int=0
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The number of optional arguments that can be used with this style.
This is useful for things like section headings, and only makes sense with
LaTeX.
Note that, on output, the optional arguments will all precede any required
arguments (see below).
So one can have constructs like:
\end_layout
\begin_deeper
\begin_layout LyX-Code
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\change_deleted -712698321 1353679722
\backslash
mycmd[opt1]{req1}{contents of paragraph}
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\change_deleted -712698321 1353679722
but one cannot have things like:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\change_deleted -712698321 1353679722
\backslash
mycmd[opt1]{req1}[opt2]{contents of paragraph}
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\change_deleted -712698321 1353679722
at least, not without ERT (with which you can have anything).
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_deeper
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ParbreakIsNewline
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Indicates that paragraphs will not be separated by an empty line in LaTeX
output, but only by a line break; together with
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
PassThru 1
\end_layout
\end_inset
, this allows to emulate a plain text editor (like the ERT inset).
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ParIndent
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string=""
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The indent of the very first line of a paragraph.
The
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Parindent
\end_layout
\end_inset
will be fixed for a certain style.
The exception is the default style, since the indentation for these paragraphs
can be prohibited with
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
NextNoIndent
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Also,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Standard
\end_layout
\end_inset
style paragraphs inside environments use the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Parindent
\end_layout
\end_inset
of the environment, not their native one.
For example,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Standard
\end_layout
\end_inset
paragraphs inside an enumeration are not indented.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Parsep
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
float=0
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The vertical space between two paragraphs of this style.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Parskip
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
float=0
\end_layout
\end_inset
] LyX allows the user to choose either
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
indent
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
or
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
skip
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
to typeset a document.
When
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
indent
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
is chosen, this value is completely ignored.
When
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
skip
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
is chosen, the parindent of a LaTeXtype
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Paragraph
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
style is ignored and all paragraphs are separated by this parskip argument.
The vertical space is calculated with
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
value
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
* DefaultHeight
\end_layout
\end_inset
where
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
DefaultHeight
\end_layout
\end_inset
is the height of a row with the normal font.
This way, the look stays the same with different screen fonts.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
PassThru
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether the contents of this paragraph should be output in raw form, meaning
without special translations that LaTeX would require.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Preamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
Information to be included in the LaTeX preamble when this style is used.
Used to define macros, load packages, etc., required by this particular
style.
Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
EndPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
RefPrefix
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The prefix to use when creating labels referring to paragraphs of this
type.
This allows the use of formatted references.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\change_deleted -712698321 1353681258
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
RequiredArgs
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
int=0
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The number of required arguments that the LaTeX command or environment
corresponding to this style expects.
In the case of a command, these are required arguments
\emph on
other than
\emph default
that associated with the content of the paragraph itself.
These do not actually have to be provided: LyX will output empty arguments
if necessary.
Note that optional arguments will be output before required arguments.
See the discussion of the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
OptionalArgs
\end_layout
\end_inset
tag above for more information.
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Requires
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether the style requires the feature
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
See the description of
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Provides
\end_layout
\end_inset
above (page
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand pageref
reference "des:FreeSpacing"
\end_inset
) for information on `features'.
2012-11-23 17:57:05 +00:00
\change_inserted -712698321 1353693134
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\change_inserted -712698321 1353693371
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353693146
ResetArgs
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353693235
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353693235
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Resets the LaTeX arguments of this style (as defined via the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353693371
Argument
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
tag).
This is useful if you have copied a style via
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353693302
CopyStyle
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
, but you do not want to inherit its (required and optional) arguments.
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\change_inserted -712698321 1353866881
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353866876
RightDelim
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353866873
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] A string that is put at the end of the layout content.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
RightMargin
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string=""
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Similar to
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LeftMargin
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Spacing
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
single
\emph default
, onehalf, double, other
\end_layout
\end_inset
\emph on
value
\emph default
] This defines what the default spacing should be in the style.
The arguments
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
single
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
onehalf
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
double
\end_layout
\end_inset
correspond respectively to a multiplier value of 1, 1.25 and 1.667.
If you specify the argument
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
other
\end_layout
\end_inset
, then you should also provide a numerical argument which will be the actual
multiplier value.
Note that, contrary to other parameters,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Spacing
\end_layout
\end_inset
implies the generation of specific LaTeX code, using the package
\family roman
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
setspace.sty
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Spellcheck
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Spellcheck paragraphs of this style.
Default is true.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TextFont
\end_layout
\end_inset
The font used for the text body .
See section
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Font-description"
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TocLevel
\end_layout
\end_inset
\series medium
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\series medium
[int]
\end_layout
\end_inset
\series default
The level of the style in the table of contents.
This is used for automatic numbering of section headings.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TopSep
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
float=0
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The vertical space with which the very first of a chain of paragraphs
with this style is separated from the previous paragraph.
If the previous paragraph has another style, the separations are not simply
added, but the maximum is taken.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sub:I18n"
\end_inset
Internationalization of Paragraph Styles
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
LyX has long supported internationalization of layout information, but,
until version 2.0, this applied only to the user interface and not to, say,
PDF output.
Thus, French authors were forced to resort to ugly hacks if they wanted
`
\lang french
Théorème
\lang english
1' instead of `Theorem 1'.
Thanks to Georg Baum, that is no longer the case.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
If a
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Style
\end_layout
\end_inset
defines text that is to appear in the typeset document, it may use
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LangPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
BabelPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
to support non-English and even multi-language documents correctly.
The following excerpt (from the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
theorems-ams.inc
\end_layout
\end_inset
file) shows how this works:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Preamble
\end_layout
\begin_deeper
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
theoremstyle{remark}
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
newtheorem{claim}[thm]{
\backslash
protect
\backslash
claimname}
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
EndPreamble
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
LangPreamble
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
providecommand{
\backslash
claimname}{_(Claim)}
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
EndLangPreamble
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
BabelPreamble
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
addto
\backslash
captions$$lang{
\backslash
renewcommand{
\backslash
claimname}{_(Claim)}}
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
EndBabelPreamble
\end_layout
\end_deeper
\begin_layout Standard
In principle, any legal LaTeX may appear in the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LangPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
BabelPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
tags, but in practice they will typically look as they do here.
The key to correct translation of the typeset text is the definition of
the LaTeX command
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
claimname
\end_layout
\end_inset
and its use in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
newtheorem
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LangPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
tag provides for internationalization based upon the overall language of
the document.
The contents of the tag will be included in the preamble, just as with
the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Preamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
tag.
What makes it special is the use of the
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
function
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
_()
\end_layout
\end_inset
, which will be replaced, when LyX produces LaTeX output, with the translation
of its argument into the document language.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
BabelPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
tag is more complex, since it is meant to provide support for multi-language
documents and so offers an interface to the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
babel
\end_layout
\end_inset
package.
Its contents will be added to the preamble once for each language that
appears in the document.
In this case, the argument to
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
_()
\end_layout
\end_inset
will be replaced with its translation into the language in question; the
expression
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$lang
\end_layout
\end_inset
is replaced by the language name (as used by the babel package).
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
A German document that also included a French section would thus have the
following in the preamble:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
addto
\backslash
captionsfrench{
\backslash
renewcommand{
\backslash
claimname}{Affirmation}}
\backslash
addto
\backslash
captionsngerman{
\backslash
renewcommand{
\backslash
claimname}{Behauptung}}
\backslash
providecommand{
\backslash
claimname}{Behauptung}
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
LaTeX and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
babel
\end_layout
\end_inset
will then conspire to produce the correct text in the output.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
One important point to note here is that the translations are provided by
LyX itself, through the
\change_inserted -195340706 1334775793
file
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -195340706 1334775793
layouttranslations
\end_layout
\end_inset
\change_deleted -195340706 1334775793
same mechanism it uses for internationalization of the user interface
\change_unchanged
.
This means, in effect, that
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LangPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
BabelPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
are really only of use in layout files that are provided with LyX, since
text entered in user-created layout files will not be seen by LyX's internation
alization routines
\change_inserted -195340706 1334775793
unless the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -195340706 1334775793
layouttranslations
\end_layout
\end_inset
file is modified accordingly
\change_unchanged
.
That said, however, any layout created with the intention that it will
be included with LyX should use these tags where appropriate.
\change_inserted -195340706 1334775793
Please note that the paragraph style translations provided by LyX will
never change with a minor update (e.g.
from version 2.1.x to 2.1.y).
It is however quite likely that a major update (e.g.
from 2.0.x to 2.1.y) will introduce new translations or corrections.
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Floats
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sub:Floats"
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Since version 1.3.0 of LyX, it is has been both possible and necessary to
define the floats (
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
figure
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
table
\end_layout
\end_inset
, \SpecialChar \ldots{}
) in the text class itself.
Standard floats are included in the file
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
stdfloats.inc
\end_layout
\end_inset
, so you may have to do no more than add
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Input stdfloats.inc
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
to your layout file.
If you want to implement a text class that proposes some other float types
(like the AGU class bundled with LyX), the information below will hopefully
help you:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Extension
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
] The file name extension of an auxiliary file for the list of figures (or
whatever).
LaTeX writes the captions to this file.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
GuiName
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
] The string that will be used in the menus and also for the caption.
This is translated to the current language if babel is used.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTML*
\end_layout
\end_inset
These are used for XHTML output.
See
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sec:Tags-for-XHTML"
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
IsPredefined
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\emph on
\begin_inset Flex Code
status open
\begin_layout Plain Layout
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
\emph default
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Indicates whether the float is already defined in the document class or
if we instead need to load
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
float.sty
\end_layout
\end_inset
and use what it provides to define it on-the-fly.
The default is
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
, which means: use
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
float.sty
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
It should be set to
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
if the float is already defined by the LaTeX document class.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ListCommand
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
] The command used to generate a list of floats of this type; the leading
`
\backslash
' should be omitted.
This
\emph on
must
\emph default
be given if
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UsesFloatPkg
\end_layout
\end_inset
is false, since there is no standard way to generate this command.
It is ignored if
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UsesFloatPkg
\end_layout
\end_inset
is true, since in that case there is a standard way to define the command.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ListName
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
] A title for a list of floats of this kind (list of figures, tables, or
whatever).
It is used for the screen label within LyX; it is passed to LaTeX for use
as the title there; and it is used as the title in XHTML output.
It will be translated to the document language.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
NumberWithin
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
] This (optional) argument determines whether floats of this class will
be numbered within some sectional unit of the document.
For example, if within is equal to
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
chapter
\end_layout
\end_inset
, the floats will be numbered within chapters.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Placement
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
] The default placement for the given class of floats.
The string should be as in standard LaTeX:
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
t
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
b
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
p
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
h
\end_layout
\end_inset
for top, bottom, page, and here, respectively.
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Note that the order of these letters in the string is irrelevant, like in
LaTeX.
\end_layout
\end_inset
On top of that there is a new type,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
H
\end_layout
\end_inset
, which does not really correspond to a float, since it means: put it
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
here
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
and nowhere else.
Note however that the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
H
\end_layout
\end_inset
specifier is special and, because of implementation details, cannot be
used in non-built in float types.
If you do not understand what this means, just use
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
tbp
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
RefPrefix
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The prefix to use when creating labels referring to floats of this type.
This allows the use of formatted references.
Note that you can remove any
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
RefPrefix
\end_layout
\end_inset
set by a copied style by using the special value
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
OFF
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
, which must be all caps.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Style
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
] The style used when defining the float using
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
newfloat
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Type
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
] The
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
type
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
of the new class of floats, like program or algorithm.
After the appropriate
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
newfloat
\end_layout
\end_inset
, commands such as
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
begin{program}
\end_layout
\end_inset
or
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
end{algorithm*}
\end_layout
\end_inset
will be available.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UsesFloatPkg
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status open
\begin_layout Plain Layout
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Tells us whether this float is defined using the facilities provided by
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
float.sty
\end_layout
\end_inset
, either by the class file or a package, or on-the-fly by LyX itself.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Note that defining a float with type
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
type
\end_layout
\end_inset
automatically defines the corresponding counter with name
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
type
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Flex insets and InsetLayout
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sub:Flex-insets-and"
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
LyX has supported character styles since version 1.4.0; as of version 1.6.0,
these are called Flex insets.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Flex insets come in three different kinds:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
character style (
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
CharStyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
): These define semantic markup corresponding to such LaTeX commands as
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
noun
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
code
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
user custom (
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Custom
\end_layout
\end_inset
): These can be used to define custom collapsible insets, similar to TeX
code, footnote, and the like.
An obvious example is an endnote inset, which is defined in the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
endnote
\end_layout
\end_inset
module.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
XML elements (
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Element
\end_layout
\end_inset
): For use with DocBook classes.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Flex insets are defined using the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
InsetLayout
\end_layout
\end_inset
tag, which shall be explained in a moment.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
InsetLayout
\end_layout
\end_inset
tag also serves another function: It can be used to customize the general
layout of many different types of insets.
Currently,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
InsetLayout
\end_layout
\end_inset
can be used to customize the layout parameters for footnotes, marginal
notes, note insets, TeX code (ERT) insets, branches, listings, indexes,
boxes, tables, algorithms, URLs, and optional arguments, as well as to
define Flex insets.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
InsetLayout
\end_layout
\end_inset
definition must begin with a line of the form:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
InsetLayout <Type>
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Here
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<Type>
\end_layout
\end_inset
indicates the inset whose layout is being defined, and here there are
\change_inserted 5863208 1334489266
three
\change_deleted 5863208 1334489267
two
\change_unchanged
cases.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Enumerate
The layout for a pre-existing inset is being modified.
In this case, can be
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<Type>
\end_layout
\end_inset
any one of the following:
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Algorithm
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Branch
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Box
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Box:shaded
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ERT
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Figure
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Foot
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Index
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Info
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Info:menu
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Info:shortcut
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Info:shortcuts
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Listings
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Marginal
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Note:Comment
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Note:Note
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Note:Greyedout
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_deleted -712698321 1353866704
Opt
\change_unchanged
Arg
\change_inserted -712698321 1353866707
ument
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Table
\end_layout
\end_inset
, or
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
URL
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Enumerate
The layout for a Flex inset is being defined.
In this case,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<Type>
\end_layout
\end_inset
must be of the form
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Flex:<name>
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
, where
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
name
\end_layout
\end_inset
may be be any valid identifier not used by a pre-existing Flex inset.
The identifier may include spaces, but in that case the whole thing must
be wrapped in quotes.
Note that the definition of a flex inset
\emph on
must
\emph default
also include a
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LyXType
\end_layout
\end_inset
entry, declaring which type of inset it defines.
\change_inserted 5863208 1334489312
\end_layout
\begin_layout Enumerate
\change_inserted 5863208 1334492248
The layout for user specific branch is being defined.
In this case,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted 5863208 1334489384
<Type>
\end_layout
\end_inset
must be of the form
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted 5863208 1334489392
Branch:<name>
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
, where
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted 5863208 1334489384
name
\end_layout
\end_inset
may be be any valid identifier of branch defined in user's document.
The identifier may include spaces, but in that case the whole thing must
be wrapped in quotes.
The main purpose of this feature is to allow LaTeX wrapping around specific
branches as user needs.
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
InsetLayout
\end_layout
\end_inset
definition can contain the following entries:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
2012-11-23 14:37:30 +00:00
\change_inserted -712698321 1353681390
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353681344
Argument
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353681344
int
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Defines argument number <int> of a command\SpecialChar \slash{}
environment associated with
the current layout.
The definition must end with
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353681344
EndArgument
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
See section
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Paragraph-Styles"
\end_inset
for details.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\change_inserted -195340706 1333913893
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
BabelPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
Preamble for changing languages.
See section
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:I18n"
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
BgColor
\end_layout
\end_inset
The color for the inset's background.
The valid colors are defined in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
src/ColorCode.h
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ContentAsLabel
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether to use the content of the inset as the label, when the inset is
closed.
Default is false.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
CopyStyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
[string]
\end_layout
\end_inset
Copies all the features of an existing style into the current one.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
CustomPars
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Indicates whether the user may employ the Paragraph Settings dialog to
customize the paragraph.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Decoration
\end_layout
\end_inset
can be
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Classic
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Minimalistic
\end_layout
\end_inset
, or
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Conglomerate
\end_layout
\end_inset
, describing the rendering style used for the inset's frame and buttons.
Footnotes generally use
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Classic
\end_layout
\end_inset
, ERT insets generally
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Minimalistic
\end_layout
\end_inset
, and character styles
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Conglomerate
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Display
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Only useful if
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LatexType
\end_layout
\end_inset
is
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Indicates whether the environment will stand on its own in LaTeX output
or will appear inline with the surrounding text.
If set to false, it is supposed that the LaTeX environment ignores white
space (including one newline character) after the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
begin{
\emph on
LatexName
\emph default
}
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
end{
\emph on
LatexName
\emph default
}
\end_layout
\end_inset
tags.
Default is true.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
End
\end_layout
\end_inset
Required at the end of the InsetLayout declarations.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Font
\end_layout
\end_inset
The font used for both the text body
\emph on
and
\emph default
the label.
See section
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Font-description"
\end_inset
.
Note that defining this font automatically defines the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelFont
\end_layout
\end_inset
to the same value, so define this first and define
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelFont
\end_layout
\end_inset
later if you want them to be different.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ForceLTR
\end_layout
\end_inset
Force the
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
latex
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
language, leading to Left-to-Right (latin) output, e.
\begin_inset space \thinspace{}
\end_inset
g.
\begin_inset space \space{}
\end_inset
in TeX code or URL.
A kludge.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ForcePlain
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Indicates whether the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
PlainLayout
\end_layout
\end_inset
should be used or, instead, the user can change the paragraph style used
in the inset.
Default is false.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
FreeSpacing
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Usually LyX doesn't allow you to insert more than one space between words,
since a space is considered as the separation between two words, not a
character or symbol of its own.
This is a very fine thing but sometimes annoying, for example, when typing
program code or plain LaTeX code.
For this reason,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
FreeSpacing
\end_layout
\end_inset
can be enabled.
Note that LyX will create protected blanks for the additional blanks when
in another mode than LaTeX-mode.
Default is false.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTML*
\end_layout
\end_inset
These tags control XHTML output.
See section
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sec:Tags-for-XHTML"
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
InToc
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether to include the contents of this inset in the strings generated
for the `Outline' pane.
One would not, for example, want the content of a footnote in a section
header to be included in the TOC displayed in the outline, but one would
normally want the content of a character style displayed.
Default is false: not to include.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
KeepEmpty
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Usually LyX does not allow you to leave a paragraph empty, since it would
lead to empty LaTeX output.
There are some cases where this could be desirable however: in a letter
template, the required fields can be provided as empty fields, so that
people do not forget them; in some special classes, a style can be used
as some kind of break, which does not contain actual text.
Default is false.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelFont
\end_layout
\end_inset
The font used for the label.
See section
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Font-description"
\end_inset
.
Note that this definition can never appear before
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Font
\end_layout
\end_inset
, lest it be ineffective.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelString
\end_layout
\end_inset
What will be displayed on the button or elsewhere as the inset label.
Some inset types (
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TeX code
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Branch
\end_layout
\end_inset
) modify this label on the fly.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\change_inserted -195340706 1333913893
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LangPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
Language dependent preamble.
See section
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:I18n"
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LatexName
\end_layout
\end_inset
The name of the corresponding LaTeX stuff.
Either the environment or command name.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LatexParam
\end_layout
\end_inset
The optional parameter for the corresponding
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LatexName
\end_layout
\end_inset
stuff, including possible bracket pairs like
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
[]
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
This parameter cannot be changed from within LyX.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LatexType
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_deleted -712698321 1353867544
\emph on
Paragraph
\emph default
,
\change_unchanged
Command, Environment,
\change_inserted -712698321 1353867573
None
\change_deleted -712698321 1353867557
Item_Environment,
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_deleted -712698321 1353867564
List_Environment
\change_unchanged
,
\change_deleted -712698321 1353867569
Bib_Environment
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
] How the style should be translated into LaTeX.
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LatexType
\end_layout
\end_inset
is perhaps a bit misleading, since these rules apply to SGML classes, too.
Visit the SGML class files for specific examples.
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_deeper
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_deleted -712698321 1353867582
Paragraph
\change_inserted -712698321 1353867583
None
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
means nothing special.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Command
\end_layout
\end_inset
means
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
\emph on
LatexName
\emph default
{\SpecialChar \ldots{}
}
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
means
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
begin{
\emph on
LatexName
\emph default
}\SpecialChar \ldots{}
\backslash
end{
\emph on
LatexName
\emph default
}
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\change_deleted -712698321 1353867600
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Item_Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
is the same as
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
, except that an
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
item
\end_layout
\end_inset
is generated for each paragraph of this environment.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
\change_deleted -712698321 1353867600
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
List_Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
is the same as
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Item_Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
, except that
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelWidthString
\end_layout
\end_inset
is passed as an argument to the environment.
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelWidthString
\end_layout
\end_inset
can be defined in the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\bar under
Edit
\bar default
\SpecialChar \menuseparator
\bar under
P
\bar default
aragraph
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
settings
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog.
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Putting the last few things together, the LaTeX output will be either:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
latexname[latexparam]{\SpecialChar \ldots{}
}
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
or:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
begin{latexname}[latexparam] \SpecialChar \ldots{}
\backslash
end{latexname}.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
depending upon the LaTeX type.
\end_layout
\end_deeper
\begin_layout Description
\change_inserted -712698321 1353866797
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353866742
LeftDelim
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353866752
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] A string that is put at the beginning of the layout content.
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LyxType
\end_layout
\end_inset
Can be
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
charstyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
custom
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
element
\end_layout
\end_inset
, or
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
end
\end_layout
\end_inset
(indicating a dummy definition ending definitions of charstyles, etc).
This entry is required in and is only meaningful for Flex insets.
Among other things, it determines on which menu this inset will appear.
Setting
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LyXType
\end_layout
\end_inset
to
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
charstyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
will set
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
MultiPar
\end_layout
\end_inset
to false.
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
MultiPar
\end_layout
\end_inset
can be set to true for charstyle insets, if you wish, by setting it
\emph on
after
\emph default
you set the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LyXType
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
MultiPar
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether multiple paragraphs are permitted in this inset.
This will also set
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
CustomPars
\end_layout
\end_inset
to the same value and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ForcePlain
\end_layout
\end_inset
to the opposite value.
These can be reset to other values, if they are used
\emph on
after
\emph default
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
MultiPar
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Default is true.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
NeedProtect
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether fragile commands in this inset should be
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
protect
\end_layout
\end_inset
'ed.
(Note: This is
\emph on
not
\emph default
whether the command should itself be protected.) Default is false.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ParbreakIsNewline
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Indicates that paragraphs will not be separated by an empty line in LaTeX
output, but only by a line break; together with
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
PassThru 1
\end_layout
\end_inset
, this allows to emulate a plain text editor (like the ERT inset).
Default is false.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
PassThru
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether the contents of this paragraph should be output in raw form, meaning
without special translations that LaTeX would require.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Preamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
Information to be included in the LaTeX preamble when this style is used.
Used to define macros, load packages, etc., required by this particular
style.
Must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
EndPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
RefPrefix
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The prefix to use when creating labels referring to insets of this type.
This allows the use of formatted references.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Requires
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether the style requires the feature
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
See the description of
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Provides
\end_layout
\end_inset
above (page
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand pageref
reference "des:FreeSpacing"
\end_inset
) for information on `features'.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ResetsFont
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether this inset should use the font of its surrounding environment
or uses its own.
Default is true: uses its own.
\change_inserted -712698321 1353866806
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\change_inserted -712698321 1353866814
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353866810
RightDelim
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\change_inserted -712698321 1353866806
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] A string that is put at the end of the layout content.
\change_unchanged
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Spellcheck
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Spellcheck the contents of this inset.
Default is true.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Counters
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sub:Counters"
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Since version 1.3.0 of LyX, it is both possible and necessary to define the
counters (
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
chapter
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
figure
\end_layout
\end_inset
, \SpecialChar \ldots{}
) in the text class itself.
The standard counters are defined in the file
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
stdcounters.inc
\end_layout
\end_inset
, so you may have to do no more than add
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Input stdcounters.inc
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
to your layout file to get them to work.
But if you want to define custom counters, then you can do so.
The counter declaration must begin with:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Counter CounterName
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
where of course `
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
CounterName
\end_layout
\end_inset
' is replaced by the name of the counter.
And it must end with
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
End
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
The following parameters can also be used:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelString
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
] When defined, this string defines how the counter is displayed.
Setting this value sets
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelStringAppendix
\end_layout
\end_inset
to the same value.
The following special constructs can be used in the string:
\end_layout
\begin_deeper
\begin_layout Itemize
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
thecounter
\end_layout
\end_inset
will be replaced by the expansion of the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelString
\end_layout
\end_inset
(or
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelStringAppendix
\end_layout
\end_inset
) of the counter
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
counter
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
counter values can be expressed using LaTeX-like macros
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
\emph on
numbertype
\emph default
{
\emph on
counter
\emph default
}
\end_layout
\end_inset
, where
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
numbertype
\end_layout
\end_inset
can be:
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\family roman
\series medium
\shape up
\size normal
\emph off
\bar no
\noun off
\color none
Actually, the situation is a bit more complicated: any
\family default
\series default
\shape default
\emph default
\bar default
\size default
\emph on
\noun default
\color inherit
numbertype
\family roman
\series medium
\shape up
\size normal
\emph off
\bar no
\noun off
other than those described below will produce arabic numerals.
It would not be surprising to see this change in the future.
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
arabic
\end_layout
\end_inset
: 1, 2, 3,\SpecialChar \ldots{}
;
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
alph
\end_layout
\end_inset
for lower-case letters: a, b, c, \SpecialChar \ldots{}
;
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Alph
\end_layout
\end_inset
for upper-case letters: A, B, C, \SpecialChar \ldots{}
;
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
roman
\end_layout
\end_inset
for lower-case roman numerals: i, ii, iii, \SpecialChar \ldots{}
;
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Roman
\end_layout
\end_inset
for upper-case roman numerals: I, II, III\SpecialChar \ldots{}
;
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
hebrew
\end_layout
\end_inset
for hebrew numerals.
\end_layout
\end_deeper
\begin_layout Standard
If LabelString is not defined, a default value is constructed as follows:
if the counter has a master counter
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
master
\end_layout
\end_inset
(defined via
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Within
\end_layout
\end_inset
), the string
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
themaster.
\backslash
arabic{counter}
\end_layout
\end_inset
is used; otherwise the string
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
arabic{counter}
\end_layout
\end_inset
is used.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelStringAppendix
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
] Same as
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelString
\end_layout
\end_inset
, but for use in the Appendix.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
PrettyFormat
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
] A format for use with formatted references to this counter.
For example, one might want to have references to section numbers appear
as
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
Section 2.4
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
The string should contain
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
##
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
This will be replaced by the counter number itself.
So, for sections, it would be: Section ##.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Within
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
] If this is set to the name of another counter, the present counter will
be reset every time the other one is increased.
For example,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
subsection
\end_layout
\end_inset
is numbered inside
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
section
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Font description
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sub:Font-description"
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
A font description looks like this:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Font
\family roman
\emph on
or
\family default
\emph default
LabelFont
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
...
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
EndFont
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The following commands are available:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Color
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
none
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
black
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
white
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
red
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
green
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
blue
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
cyan
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
magenta
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
yellow
\end_layout
\end_inset
]
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Family
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
Roman
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Sans
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Typewriter
\end_layout
\end_inset
]
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Misc
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Valid arguments are:
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
emph
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
noun
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
strikeout
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
underbar
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
uuline
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
uwave
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
no_emph
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
no_noun
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
no_strikeout
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
no_bar
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
no_uuline
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
no_uwave
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Each of these turns on or off the corresponding attribute.
For example,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
emph
\end_layout
\end_inset
turns on emphasis, and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
no_emph
\end_layout
\end_inset
turns it off.
\begin_inset Newline newline
\end_inset
If the latter seems puzzling, remember that the font settings for the present
context are generally inherited from the surrounding context.
So
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
no_emph
\end_layout
\end_inset
would turn off the emphasis that was anyway in effect, say, in a theorem
environment.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Series
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
Medium
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Bold
\end_layout
\end_inset
]
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Shape
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
Up
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Italic
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
SmallCaps
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Slanted
\end_layout
\end_inset
]
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Size
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
tiny
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
small
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
normal
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
large
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
larger
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
largest
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
huge
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
giant
\end_layout
\end_inset
]
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sub:Citation-format-description"
\end_inset
Citation format description
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
CiteFormat
\end_layout
\end_inset
blocks are used to describe how bibliographic information should be displayed,
both within LyX itself (in the citation dialog and in tooltips, for example)
and in XHTML output.
Such a block might look like this:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
CiteFormat
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
article ...
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
book ...
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
End
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The individual lines define how the bibliographic information associated
with an article or book, respectively, is to be displayed, and such a definitio
n can be given for any `entry type' that might be present in a BibTeX file.
LyX defines a default format in the source code that will be used if no
specific definition has been given.
LyX predefines several formats in the file
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
stdciteformats.inc
\end_layout
\end_inset
, which is included in most of LyX's document classes.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The definitions use a simple language that allows BibTeX keys to be replaced
with their values.
Keys should be enclosed in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
%
\end_layout
\end_inset
signs, e.g.:
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
%author%
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
So a simple definition might look like this:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
misc %author%,
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
%title
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
This would print the author, followed by a comma, followed by the title,
in quotes, followed by a period.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Of course, sometimes you may want to print a key only if it exists.
This can be done by using a conditional construction, such as:
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
{%volume%[[vol.
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
%volume%]]}
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
This says: If the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
volume
\end_layout
\end_inset
key exists, then print
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
vol.
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
followed by the volume key.
It is also possible to have an else clause in the conditional, such as:
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
{%author%[[%author%]][[%editor%, ed.]]}
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Here, the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
author
\end_layout
\end_inset
key is printed if it exists; otherwise, the editor key is printed, followed
by
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
ed.
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
Note that the key is again enclosed in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
%
\end_layout
\end_inset
signs; the entire conditional is enclosed in braces; and the if and else
clauses are enclosed in double brackets,
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
[[
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
]]
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
There must be no space between any of these.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
There is one other piece of syntax available in definitions, which looks
like this:
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
{!<i>!}
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
This defines a piece of formatting information that is to be used when
creating
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
rich text
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
Obviously, we do not want to output HTML tags when writing plain text,
so they should be wrapped in
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
{!
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
!}
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Two special sorts of definitions are also possible in a
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
CiteFormat
\end_layout
\end_inset
block.
An example of the first would be:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
!quotetitle
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
%title%
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
This is an abbreviation, or macro, and it can be used by treating it as
if it were a key:
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
%!quotetitle%
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
LyX will treat
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
%!quotetitle%
\end_layout
\end_inset
exactly as it would treat its definition.
So, let us issue the obvious
\emph on
warning
\emph default
.
Do not do this:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
!funfun %funfun%
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
or anything like it.
LyX shouldn't go into an infinite loop, but it may go into a long one before
it gives up.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The second sort of special definition might look like this:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
_pptext pp.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
This defines a translatable piece of text, which allows relevant parts of
the bibliography to be translated.
It can be included in a definition by treating it as a key:
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
%_pptext%
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Several of these are predefined in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
stdciteformats.inc
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Note that these are not macros, in the sense just defined.
They will not be expanded.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
So here then is an example that use all these features:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
!authoredit {%author%[[%author%, ]][[{%editor%[[%editor%, %_edtext%, ]]}]]}
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
This defines a macro that prints the author, followed by a comma, if the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
author
\end_layout
\end_inset
key is defined, or else prints the name of the editor, followed by the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
_edtext
\end_layout
\end_inset
or its translation (it is by default
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
ed.
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
), if the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
editor
\end_layout
\end_inset
key is defined.
Note that this is in fact defined in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
stdciteformats.inc
\end_layout
\end_inset
, so you can use it in your own definitions, or re-definitions, if you load
that file first.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Section
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sec:Tags-for-XHTML"
\end_inset
Tags for XHTML output
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
As with LaTeX or DocBook, the format of LyX's XHTML output is also controlled
by layout information.
In general, LyX provides sensible defaults and, as mentioned earlier, it
will even construct default CSS style rules from the other layout tags.
For example, LyX will attempt to use the information provided in the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Font
\end_layout
\end_inset
declaration for the Chapter style to write CSS that will appropriately
format chapter headings.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
In many cases, then, you may not have to do anything at all to get acceptable
XHTML output for your own environments, custom insets, and so forth.
But in some cases you will, and so LyX provides a number of layout tags
that can be used to customize the XHTML and CSS that are generated.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Note that there are two tags,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
AddToHTMLPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
that may appear outside style and inset declarations.
See
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:General-text-class"
\end_inset
for details on these.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sub:Paragraph-Style-XHTML"
\end_inset
Paragraph styles
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The sort of XHTML LyX outputs for a paragraph depends upon whether we are
dealing with a normal paragraph, a command, or an environment, where this
is itself determined by the contents of the corresponding
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LaTeXType
\end_layout
\end_inset
tag.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
For a command or normal paragraph, the output XHTML has the following form:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
<tag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
>
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
<labeltag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
>Label</labeltag>
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Contents of the paragraph.
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
</tag>
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The label tags are of course omitted if the paragraph does not have a label.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
For an environment that is not some sort of list, the XHTML takes this form:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
<tag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
>
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
<itemtag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
><labeltag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
>Environment Label</labeltag>First paragraph.</itemtag>
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
<itemtag>Second paragraph.</itemtag>
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
</tag>
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Note that the label is output only for the first paragraph, as it should
be for a theorem, for example.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
For a list, we have one of these forms:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
<tag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
>
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
<itemtag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
><labeltag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
>List Label</labeltag>First item.</itemtag>
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
<itemtag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
><labeltag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
>List Label</labeltag>Second item.</itemtag>
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
</tag>
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
<tag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
>
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
<labeltag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
>List Label</labeltag><itemtag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
>First item.</itemtag>
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
<labeltag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
>List Label</labeltag><itemtag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
>Second item.</itemtag>
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
</tag>
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Note the different orders of
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
labeltag
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
itemtag
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Which order we get depends upon the setting of
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLLabelFirst
\end_layout
\end_inset
: If
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLLabelFirst
\end_layout
\end_inset
is false (the default), you get the first of these, with the label within
the item; if true, you get the second, with the label outside the item.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The specific tags and attributes output for each paragraph type can be controlle
d by means of the layout tags we are about to describe.
As mentioned earlier, however, LyX uses sensible defaults for many of these,
so you often may not need to do very much to get good XHTML output.
Think of the available tags as there so you can tweak things to your liking.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLAttr
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Specifies attribute information to be output with the main tag.
For example,
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
class=`mydiv'
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
By default, LyX will output
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
class=`layoutname'
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
, where
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
layoutname
\end_layout
\end_inset
is the LyX name of the layout, made lowercase, for example: chapter.
This should
\emph on
not
\emph default
contain any style information.
Use
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLStyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
for that purpose.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLForceCSS
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\emph default
,1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether to output the default CSS information LyX generates for this layout,
even if additional information is explicitly provided via
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLStyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Setting this to
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
allows you to alter or augment the generated CSS, rather than to override
it completely.
Default is
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLItem
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The tag to be used for individual paragraphs of environments, replacing
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
itemtag
\end_layout
\end_inset
in the examples above.
Defaults to
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
div
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLItemAttr
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Attributes for the item tag.
Defaults to
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
class=`layoutname_item'
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
This should
\emph on
not
\emph default
contain any style information.
Use
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLStyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
for that purpose.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLLabel
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The tag to be used for paragraph and item labels, replacing
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
labeltag
\end_layout
\end_inset
in the examples above.
Defaults to
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
span
\end_layout
\end_inset
, unless
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LabelType
\end_layout
\end_inset
is either
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Top_Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
or
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Centered_Top_Environment
\end_layout
\end_inset
, in which case it defaults to
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
div
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLLabelAttr
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Attributes for the label tag.
Defaults to
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
class=`layoutname_label'
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
This should
\emph on
not
\emph default
contain any style information.
Use
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLStyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
for that purpose.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLLabelFirst
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\emph default
,1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Meaningful only for list-like environments, this tag controls whether
the label tag is output before or inside the item tag.
This is used, for example, in the description environment, where we want
`
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<dt>\SpecialChar \ldots{}
</dt><dd>\SpecialChar \ldots{}
</dd>
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Default is
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
0
\end_layout
\end_inset
: The label tag is output inside the item tag.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
Information to be output in the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<head>
\end_layout
\end_inset
section when this style is used.
This might, for example, be used to include a
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<script>
\end_layout
\end_inset
block defining an
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
onclick
\end_layout
\end_inset
handler.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLStyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
CSS style information to be included when this style is used.
Note that this will automatically be wrapped in a layout-generated
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<style>
\end_layout
\end_inset
block, so only the CSS itself need be included.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLTag
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The tag to be used for the main label, replacing
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
tag
\end_layout
\end_inset
in the examples above.
Defaults to
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
div
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLTitle
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\emph default
,1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Marks this style as the one to be used to generate the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<title>
\end_layout
\end_inset
tag for the XHTML file.
By default, it is false.
The
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
stdtitle.inc
\end_layout
\end_inset
file sets it to true for the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
title
\end_layout
\end_inset
environment.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
InsetLayout XHTML
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The XHTML output of insets can also be controlled by information in layout
files.
\begin_inset Foot
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
At present, this is true only for
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
text
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
insets (insets you can type into) and is not true for
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
command
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
insets (insets that are associated with dialog boxes).
\end_layout
\end_inset
Here, too, LyX tries to provide sensible defaults, and it constructs default
CSS style rules.
But everything can be customized.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The XHTML LyX outputs for an inset has the following form:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
<tag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
>
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
<labeltag>Label</labeltag>
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
<innertag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
>Contents of the inset.</innertag>
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
</tag>
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
If the inset permits multiple paragraphs---that is, if
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
MultiPar
\end_layout
\end_inset
is true---then the contents of the inset will itself be output as paragraphs
formatted according to the styles used for those paragraphs (standard,
quote, and the like).
The label tag is of course omitted if the paragraph does not have a label
and, at present, is always
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
span
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
The inner tag is optional and, by default, does not appear.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The specific tags and attributes output for each inset can be controlled
by means of the following layout tags.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLAttr
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Specifies attribute information to be output with the main tag.
For example,
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
class=`myinset' onclick=`\SpecialChar \ldots{}
'
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
By default, LyX will output
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
class=`insetname'
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
, where
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
insetname
\end_layout
\end_inset
is the LyX name of the inset, made lowercase and with non-alphanumeric
characters converted to underscores, for example: footnote.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLForceCSS
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\emph on
0
\emph default
,1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether to output the default CSS information LyX generates for this layout,
even if additional information is explicitly provided via
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLStyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Setting this to
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
allows you to alter or augment the generated CSS, rather than to override
it completely.
Default is 0.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLInnerAttr
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Attributes for the inner tag.
Defaults to
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
class=`insetname_inner'
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLInnerTag
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The inner tag, replacing
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
innertag
\end_layout
\end_inset
in the examples above.
By default, there is none.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLIsBlock
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
0,
\emph on
1
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Whether this inset represents a standalone block of text (such as a footnote)
or instead represents material that is included in the surrounding text
(such as a branch).
Defaults to 1.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLLabel
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] A label for this inset, possibly including a reference to a counter.
For example, for footnote, it might be:
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
arabic{footnote}
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
This is optional, and there is no default.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLPreamble
\end_layout
\end_inset
Information to be output in the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<head>
\end_layout
\end_inset
section when this style is used.
This might, for example, be used to include a
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<script>
\end_layout
\end_inset
block defining an
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
onclick
\end_layout
\end_inset
handler.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLStyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
CSS style information to be included when this style is used.
Note that this will automatically be wrapped in a layout-generated
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<style>
\end_layout
\end_inset
block, so only the CSS itself need be included.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLTag
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The tag to be used for the main label, replacing
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
tag
\end_layout
\end_inset
in the examples above.
The default depends upon the setting of
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
MultiPar
\end_layout
\end_inset
: If
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
MultiPar
\end_layout
\end_inset
is true, the default is
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
div
\end_layout
\end_inset
; if it is false, the default is
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
span
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Float XHTML
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The XHTML output for floats too can be controlled by layout information.
The output has the following form:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
<tag attr=
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
value
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
>
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Contents of the float.
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
</tag>
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The caption, if there is one, is a separate inset and will be output as
such.
Its appearance can be controlled via the InsetLayout for caption insets.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLAttr
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] Specifies attribute information to be output with the main tag.
For example,
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
class=`myfloat' onclick=`\SpecialChar \ldots{}
'
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
By default, LyX will output
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
class=`float float-floattype'
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
, where
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
floattype
\end_layout
\end_inset
is LyX's name for this type of float, as determined by the float declaration
(see
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Floats"
\end_inset
), though made lowercase and with non-alphanumeric characters converted
to underscores, for example: float-table.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLStyle
\end_layout
\end_inset
CSS style information to be included when this float is used.
Note that this will automatically be wrapped in a layout-generated
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<style>
\end_layout
\end_inset
block, so only the CSS itself need be included.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HTMLTag
\end_layout
\end_inset
[
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
string
\end_layout
\end_inset
] The tag to be used for this float, replacing
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
tag
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
in the example above.
The default is
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
div
\end_layout
\end_inset
and will rarely need changing.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Bibliography formatting
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The bibliography can be formatted using
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
CiteFormat
\end_layout
\end_inset
blocks.
See Section
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Citation-format-description"
\end_inset
for the details.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
LyX-generated CSS
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
We have several times mentioned that LyX will generate default CSS style
rules for both insets and paragraph styles, based upon the other layout
information that is provided.
In this section, we shall say a word about which layout information LyX
uses and how.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
At present, LyX auto-generates CSS only for font information, making use
of the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Family
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Series
\end_layout
\end_inset
,
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Shape
\end_layout
\end_inset
, and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Size
\end_layout
\end_inset
specified in the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Font
\end_layout
\end_inset
declaration.
(See
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sub:Font-description"
\end_inset
.) The translation is mostly straightforward and obvious.
For example,
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Family Sans
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
becomes
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
font-family: sans-serif;
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
.
The correspondence of LyX sizes and CSS sizes is a little less obvious
but nonetheless intuitive.
See the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
getSizeCSS()
\end_layout
\end_inset
function in
\begin_inset Flex URL
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
src/FontInfo.cpp
\end_layout
\end_inset
for the details.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Chapter
Including External Material
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
\begin_inset Box Shadowbox
position "t"
hor_pos "c"
has_inner_box 1
inner_pos "t"
use_parbox 0
use_makebox 0
width "100col%"
special "none"
height "1in"
height_special "totalheight"
status open
\begin_layout Plain Layout
WARNING: This portion of the documentation has not been updated for some
time.
We certainly hope that it is still accurate, but there are no guarantees.
\end_layout
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The use of material from sources external to LyX is covered in detail in
the
\emph on
Embedded Objects
\emph default
manual.
This part of the manual covers what needs to happen behind the scenes for
new sorts of material to be included.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Section
How does it work?
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The external material feature is based on the concept of a
\emph on
template
\emph default
.
A template is a specification of how LyX should interface with a certain
kind of material.
As bundled, LyX comes with predefined templates for Xfig figures, various
raster format images, chess diagrams, and LilyPond music notation.
You can check the actual list by using the menu
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Insert\SpecialChar \menuseparator
File\SpecialChar \menuseparator
External Material
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
Furthermore, it is possible to roll your own template to support a specific
kind of material.
Later we'll describe in more detail what is involved, and hopefully you
will submit all the templates you create so we can include them in a later
LyX version.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Another basic idea of the external material feature is to distinguish between
the original file that serves as a base for final material and the produced
file that is included in your exported or printed document.
For example, consider the case of a figure produced with
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Xfig
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
The Xfig application itself works on an original file with the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.fig
\end_layout
\end_inset
extension.
Within Xfig, you create and change your figure, and when you are done,
you save the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
fig
\end_layout
\end_inset
-file.
When you want to include the figure in your document, you invoke
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
transfig
\end_layout
\end_inset
in order to create a PostScript file that can readily be included in your
LaTeX file.
In this case, the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.fig
\end_layout
\end_inset
file is the original file, and the PostScript file is the produced file.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
This distinction is important in order to allow updating of the material
while you are in the process of writing the document.
Furthermore, it provides us with the flexibility that is needed to support
multiple export formats.
For instance, in the case of a plain text file, it is not exactly an award-winn
ing idea to include the figure as raw PostScript.
Instead, you would either prefer to just include a reference to the figure
or try to invoke some graphics to ASCII converter to make the final result
look similar to the real graphics.
The external material management allows you to do this, because it is parametri
zed on the different export formats that LyX supports.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Besides supporting the production of different products according to the
exported format, it supports tight integration with editing and viewing
applications.
In the case of an Xfig figure, you are able to invoke Xfig on the original
file with a single click from within the external material dialog in LyX,
and also preview the produced PostScript file with Ghostview with another
click.
No more fiddling around with the command line and/or file browsers to locate
and manipulate the original or produced files.
In this way, you are finally able to take full advantage of the many different
applications that are relevant to use when you write your documents, and
ultimately be more productive.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Section
The external template configuration file
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
It is relatively easy to add custom external template definitions to LyX.
However, be aware that doing this in an careless manner most probably
\emph on
will
\emph default
introduce an easily exploitable security hole.
So before you do this, please read the discussion about security in section
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sec:Security-discussion"
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Having said that, we encourage you to submit any interesting templates that
you create.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The external templates are defined in the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
LyXDir/lib/external_templates
\end_layout
\end_inset
file.
You can place your own version in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UserDir/external_templates
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
A typical template looks like this:
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Template XFig
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
GuiName "XFig: $$AbsOrRelPathParent$$Basename"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
HelpText
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
An XFig figure.
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
HelpTextEnd
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
InputFormat fig
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
FileFilter "*.fig"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
AutomaticProduction true
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Transform Rotate
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Transform Resize
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Format LaTeX
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
TransformCommand Rotate RotationLatexCommand
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
TransformCommand Resize ResizeLatexCommand
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Product "$$RotateFront$$ResizeFront
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
\backslash
input{$$AbsOrRelPathMaster$$Basename.pstex_t}
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
$$ResizeBack$$RotateBack"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
UpdateFormat pstex
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
UpdateResult "$$AbsPath$$Basename.pstex_t"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Requirement "graphicx"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
ReferencedFile latex "$$AbsOrRelPathMaster$$Basename.pstex_t"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
ReferencedFile latex "$$AbsPath$$Basename.eps"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
ReferencedFile dvi "$$AbsPath$$Basename.eps"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
FormatEnd
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Format PDFLaTeX
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
TransformCommand Rotate RotationLatexCommand
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
TransformCommand Resize ResizeLatexCommand
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Product "$$RotateFront$$ResizeFront
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
\backslash
\backslash
input{$$AbsOrRelPathMaster$$Basename.pdftex_t}
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
$$ResizeBack$$RotateBack"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
UpdateFormat pdftex
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
UpdateResult "$$AbsPath$$Basename.pdftex_t"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Requirement "graphicx"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
ReferencedFile latex "$$AbsOrRelPathMaster$$Basename.pdftex_t"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
ReferencedFile latex "$$AbsPath$$Basename.pdf"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
FormatEnd
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Format Ascii
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Product "$$Contents(
\backslash
"$$AbsPath$$Basename.asc
\backslash
")"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
UpdateFormat asciixfig
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
UpdateResult "$$AbsPath$$Basename.asc"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
FormatEnd
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Format DocBook
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Product "<graphic fileref=
\backslash
"$$AbsOrRelPathMaster$$Basename.eps
\backslash
">
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
</graphic>"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
UpdateFormat eps
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
UpdateResult "$$AbsPath$$Basename.eps"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
ReferencedFile docbook "$$AbsPath$$Basename.eps"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
ReferencedFile docbook-xml "$$AbsPath$$Basename.eps"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
FormatEnd
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
Product "[XFig: $$FName]"
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
FormatEnd
\end_layout
\begin_layout LyX-Code
TemplateEnd
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
As you can see, the template is enclosed in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Template
\end_layout
\end_inset
\SpecialChar \ldots{}
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TemplateEnd
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
It contains a header specifying some general settings and, for each supported
primary document file format, a section
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Format
\end_layout
\end_inset
\SpecialChar \ldots{}
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
FormatEnd
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
The template header
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
AutomaticProduction
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
true|false
\end_layout
\end_inset
Whether the file represented by the template must be generated by LyX.
This command must occur exactly once.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
FileFilter
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
<pattern>
\end_layout
\end_inset
A glob pattern that is used in the file dialog to filter out the desired
files.
If there is more than one possible file extension (e.
\begin_inset space \thinspace{}
\end_inset
g.
\begin_inset space \space{}
\end_inset
tgif has
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.obj
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.tgo
\end_layout
\end_inset
), use something like
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
"*.{obj,tgo}"
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
This command must occur exactly once.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
GuiName
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
<guiname>
\end_layout
\end_inset
The text that is displayed on the button.
This command must occur exactly once.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
HelpText
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
<text>
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
HelpTextEnd
\end_layout
\end_inset
The help text that is used in the External dialog.
Provide enough information to explain to the user just what the template
can provide him with.
This command must occur exactly once.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
InputFormat
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
<format>
\end_layout
\end_inset
The file format of the original file.
This must be the name of a format that is known to LyX (see section
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
\begin_inset CommandInset ref
LatexCommand ref
reference "sec:Formats"
\end_inset
).
Use
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
*
\end_layout
\end_inset
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
if the template can handle original files of more than one format.
LyX will attempt to interrogate the file itself in order to deduce its
format in this case.
This command must occur exactly once.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Template
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
<id>
\end_layout
\end_inset
A unique name for the template.
It must not contain substitution macros (see below).
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Transform
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
Rotate|Resize|Clip|Extra
\end_layout
\end_inset
This command specifies which transformations are supported by this template.
It may occur zero or more times.
This command enables the corresponding tabs in the external dialog.
Each
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Transform
\end_layout
\end_inset
command must have either a corresponding
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TransformCommand
\end_layout
\end_inset
or a
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TransformOption
\end_layout
\end_inset
command in the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Format
\end_layout
\end_inset
section.
Otherwise the transformation will not be supported by that format.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
The Format section
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Format
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
LaTeX|PDFLaTeX|PlainText|DocBook
\end_layout
\end_inset
The primary document file format that this format definition is for.
Not every template has a sensible representation in all document file formats.
Please define nevertheless a
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Format
\end_layout
\end_inset
section for all templates.
Use a dummy text when no representation is available.
Then you can at least see a reference to the external material in the exported
document.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Option
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
<name>
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
<value>
\end_layout
\end_inset
This command defines an additional macro
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$<name>
\end_layout
\end_inset
for substitution in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Product
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<value>
\end_layout
\end_inset
itself may contain substitution macros.
The advantage over using
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
<value>
\end_layout
\end_inset
directly in
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Product
\end_layout
\end_inset
is that the substituted value of
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$<name>
\end_layout
\end_inset
is sanitized so that it is a valid optional argument in the document format.
This command may occur zero or more times.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Product
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
<text>
\end_layout
\end_inset
The text that is inserted in the exported document.
This is actually the most important command and can be quite complex.
This command must occur exactly once.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Preamble
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
<name>
\end_layout
\end_inset
This command specifies a preamble snippet that will be included in the
LaTeX preamble.
It has to be defined using
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
PreambleDef
\end_layout
\end_inset
\SpecialChar \ldots{}
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
PreambleDefEnd
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
This command may occur zero or more times.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ReferencedFile
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
<format>
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
<filename>
\end_layout
\end_inset
This command denotes files that are created by the conversion process and
are needed for a particular export format.
If the filename is relative, it is interpreted relative to the master document.
This command may be given zero or more times.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Requirement
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
<package>
\end_layout
\end_inset
The name of a required LaTeX package.
The package is included via
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\backslash
usepackage{}
\end_layout
\end_inset
in the LaTeX preamble.
This command may occur zero or more times.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TransformCommand
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
Rotate
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
RotationLatexCommand
\end_layout
\end_inset
This command specifies that the built in LaTeX command should be used for
rotation.
This command may occur once or not at all.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TransformCommand
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
Resize
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
ResizeLatexCommand
\end_layout
\end_inset
This command specifies that the built in LaTeX command should be used for
resizing.
This command may occur once or not at all.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TransformOption
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
Rotate
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
RotationLatexOption
\end_layout
\end_inset
This command specifies that rotation is done via an optional argument.
This command may occur once or not at all.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TransformOption
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
Resize
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
ResizeLatexOption
\end_layout
\end_inset
This command specifies that resizing is done via an optional argument.
This command may occur once or not at all.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TransformOption
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
Clip
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
ClipLatexOption
\end_layout
\end_inset
This command specifies that clipping is done via an optional argument.
This command may occur once or not at all.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TransformOption
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
Extra
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
ExtraLatexOption
\end_layout
\end_inset
This command specifies that an extra optional argument is used.
This command may occur once or not at all.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UpdateFormat
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
<format>
\end_layout
\end_inset
The file format of the converted file.
This must be the name of a format that is known to LyX (see the
\begin_inset Flex MenuItem
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
\bar under
T
\bar default
ools\SpecialChar \menuseparator
\bar under
P
\bar default
references\SpecialChar \menuseparator
File Handling\SpecialChar \menuseparator
File Format
\end_layout
\end_inset
dialog).
This command must occur exactly once.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
UpdateResult
\begin_inset space ~
\end_inset
<filename>
\end_layout
\end_inset
The file name of the converted file.
The file name must be absolute.
This command must occur exactly once.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Subsection
Preamble definitions
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The external template configuration file may contain additional preamble
definitions enclosed by
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
PreambleDef
\end_layout
\end_inset
\SpecialChar \ldots{}
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
PreambleDefEnd
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
They can be used by the templates in the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Format
\end_layout
\end_inset
section.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Section
The substitution mechanism
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
When the external material facility invokes an external program, it is done
on the basis of a command defined in the template configuration file.
These commands can contain various macros that are expanded before execution.
Execution always take place in the directory of the containing document.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Also, whenever external material is to be displayed, the name will be produced
by the substitution mechanism, and most other commands in the template
definition support substitution as well.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The available macros are the following:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$AbsOrRelPathMaster
\end_layout
\end_inset
The file path, absolute or relative to the master LyX document.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$AbsOrRelPathParent
\end_layout
\end_inset
The file path, absolute or relative to the LyX document.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$AbsPath
\end_layout
\end_inset
The absolute file path.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$Basename
\end_layout
\end_inset
The filename without path and without the extension.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$Contents(
\begin_inset Quotes eld
\end_inset
filename.ext
\begin_inset Quotes erd
\end_inset
)
\end_layout
\end_inset
This macro will expand to the contents of the file with the name
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
filename.ext
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$Extension
\end_layout
\end_inset
The file extension (including the dot).
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$FName
\end_layout
\end_inset
The filename of the file specified in the external material dialog.
This is either an absolute name, or it is relative to the LyX document.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$FPath
\end_layout
\end_inset
The path part of
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$FName
\end_layout
\end_inset
(absolute name or relative to the LyX document).
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$RelPathMaster
\end_layout
\end_inset
The file path, relative to the master LyX document.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$RelPathParent
\end_layout
\end_inset
The file path, relative to the LyX document.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$Sysdir
\end_layout
\end_inset
This macro will expand to the absolute path of the system directory.
This is typically used to point to the various helper scripts that are
bundled with LyX.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$Tempname
\end_layout
\end_inset
A name and full path to a temporary file which will be automatically deleted
whenever the containing document is closed, or the external material insertion
deleted.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
All path macros contain a trailing directory separator, so you can construct
e.
\begin_inset space \thinspace{}
\end_inset
g.
\begin_inset space \space{}
\end_inset
the absolute filename with
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$AbsPath$$Basename$$Extension
\end_layout
\end_inset
.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The macros above are substituted in all commands unless otherwise noted.
The command
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Product
\end_layout
\end_inset
supports additionally the following substitutions if they are enabled by
the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Transform
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TransformCommand
\end_layout
\end_inset
commands:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$ResizeFront
\end_layout
\end_inset
The front part of the resize command.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$ResizeBack
\end_layout
\end_inset
The back part of the resize command.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$RotateFront
\end_layout
\end_inset
The front part of the rotation command.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$RotateBack
\end_layout
\end_inset
The back part of the rotation command.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The value string of the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Option
\end_layout
\end_inset
command supports additionally the following substitutions if they are enabled
by the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
Transform
\end_layout
\end_inset
and
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
TransformOption
\end_layout
\end_inset
commands:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$Clip
\end_layout
\end_inset
The clip option.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$Extra
\end_layout
\end_inset
The extra option.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$Resize
\end_layout
\end_inset
The resize option.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Description
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$Rotate
\end_layout
\end_inset
The rotation option.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
You may ask why there are so many path macros.
There are mainly two reasons:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Enumerate
Relative and absolute file names should remain relative or absolute, respectivel
y.
Users may have reasons to prefer either form.
Relative names are useful for portable documents that should work on different
machines, for example.
Absolute names may be required by some programs.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Enumerate
LaTeX treats relative file names differently than LyX and other programs
in nested included files.
For LyX, a relative file name is always relative to the document that contains
the file name.
For LaTeX, it is always relative to the master document.
These two definitions are identical if you have only one document, but
differ if you have a master document that includes part documents.
That means that relative filenames must be transformed when presented to
LaTeX.
Fortunately LyX does this automatically for you if you choose the right
macros.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
So which path macro should be used in new template definitions? The rule
is not difficult:
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
Use
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$AbsPath
\end_layout
\end_inset
if an absolute path is required.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
Use
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$AbsOrRelPathMaster
\end_layout
\end_inset
if the substituted string is some kind of LaTeX input.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Itemize
Else use
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
$$AbsOrRelPathParent
\end_layout
\end_inset
in order to preserve the user's choice.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
There are special cases where this rule does not work and e.
\begin_inset space \thinspace{}
\end_inset
g.
\begin_inset space \space{}
\end_inset
relative names are needed, but normally it will work just fine.
One example for such a case is the command
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
ReferencedFile latex "$$AbsOrRelPathMaster$$Basename.pstex_t"
\end_layout
\end_inset
in the XFig template above: We can't use the absolute name because the
copier for
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
.pstex_t
\end_layout
\end_inset
files needs the relative name in order to rewrite the file content.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Section
Security discussion
\begin_inset CommandInset label
LatexCommand label
name "sec:Security-discussion"
\end_inset
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
The external material feature interfaces with a lot of external programs
and does so automatically, so we have to consider the security implications
of this.
In particular, since you have the option of including your own filenames
and/or parameter strings and those are expanded into a command, it seems
that it would be possible to create a malicious document which executes
arbitrary commands when a user views or prints the document.
This is something we definitely want to avoid.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
However, since the external program commands are specified in the template
configuration file only, there are no security issues if LyX is properly
configured with safe templates only.
This is so because the external programs are invoked with the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
execvp
\end_layout
\end_inset
-system call rather than the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
system
\end_layout
\end_inset
system-call, so it's not possible to execute arbitrary commands from the
filename or parameter section via the shell.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
This also implies that you are restricted in what command strings you can
use in the external material templates.
In particular, pipes and redirection are not readily available.
This has to be so if LyX should remain safe.
If you want to use some of the shell features, you should write a safe
script to do this in a controlled manner, and then invoke the script from
the command string.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
It is possible to design a template that interacts directly with the shell,
but since this would allow a malicious user to execute arbitrary commands
by writing clever filenames and/or parameters, we generally recommend that
you only use safe scripts that work with the
\begin_inset Flex Code
status collapsed
\begin_layout Plain Layout
execvp
\end_layout
\end_inset
system call in a controlled manner.
Of course, for use in a controlled environment, it can be tempting to just
fall back to use ordinary shell scripts.
If you do so, be aware that you
\emph on
will
\emph default
provide an easily exploitable security hole in your system.
Of course it stands to reason that such unsafe templates will never be
included in the standard LyX distribution, although we do encourage people
to submit new templates in the open source tradition.
But LyX as shipped from the official distribution channels will never have
unsafe templates.
\end_layout
\begin_layout Standard
Including external material provides a lot of power, and you have to be
careful not to introduce security hazards with this power.
A subtle error in a single line in an innocent looking script can open
the door to huge security problems.
So if you do not fully understand the issues, we recommend that you consult
a knowledgeable security professional or the LyX development team if you
have any questions about whether a given template is safe or not.
And do this before you use it in an uncontrolled environment.
\end_layout
\end_body
\end_document